1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.92"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
374 .cindex "documentation"
375 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
376 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
377 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
378 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
381 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
382 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
383 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
384 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
385 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
386 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 .cindex "books about Exim"
390 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
391 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
392 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
393 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
395 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
396 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
397 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
398 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
400 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
401 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
402 Debian-specific features in the file
403 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
404 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
408 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
410 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
411 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
412 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
413 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
414 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
416 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
417 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
418 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
419 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
421 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
422 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
424 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
425 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
426 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
430 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
431 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
432 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
433 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
434 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
435 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
436 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
437 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
441 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
442 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
446 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
449 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
450 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
451 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
455 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
456 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
457 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
458 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
459 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
460 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
461 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
464 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
465 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
466 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
467 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
470 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
471 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
472 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
476 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
477 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
478 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
482 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
483 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
484 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
485 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
490 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
493 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
494 .cindex "bug reports"
495 .cindex "reporting bugs"
496 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
497 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
498 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
499 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
503 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
505 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
506 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
507 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
508 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
510 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
512 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
513 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
515 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
516 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
517 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
519 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
520 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
521 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
522 here are top-level directories.
524 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
527 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
534 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
536 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
537 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
538 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
539 most portable to old systems.
541 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
542 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
543 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
544 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
545 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
546 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
547 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
548 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
549 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
550 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
551 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
553 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
554 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
555 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
556 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
558 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
560 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
561 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
565 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
566 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
569 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
570 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
571 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
574 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
579 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
582 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
585 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
586 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
587 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
588 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
589 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
590 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .cindex "domainless addresses"
593 .cindex "address" "without domain"
594 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
595 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
596 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
597 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
600 .cindex "transport" "external"
601 .cindex "external transports"
602 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
603 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
604 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
605 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
606 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
607 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
610 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
611 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
614 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
615 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
616 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
617 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
618 a number of common scanners are provided.
622 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
623 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
624 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
625 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
626 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
627 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
630 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
631 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
632 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
633 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
634 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
635 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
636 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
637 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
638 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
639 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
640 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
641 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
644 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
645 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
646 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
650 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
651 .cindex "terminology definitions"
652 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
653 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
654 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
655 below) by a blank line.
657 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
658 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
659 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
660 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
661 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
662 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
663 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
664 rise to further bounce messages.
666 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
667 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
668 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
671 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
672 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
673 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
676 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
677 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
678 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
681 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
682 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
683 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
684 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
685 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
686 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
687 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
690 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
691 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
692 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
693 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
694 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
697 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
698 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
699 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
700 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
701 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
704 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
705 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
706 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
707 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
708 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
711 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
714 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
715 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
716 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
717 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
718 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
721 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
722 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
723 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
724 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
727 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
728 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
729 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
730 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
731 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
742 .cindex "incorporated code"
743 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
746 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
749 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
750 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
751 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
752 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
753 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
754 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
757 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
758 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
759 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
760 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
761 following statements:
764 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
767 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
768 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
771 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
772 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
773 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
774 restrictions applied to it).
777 .cindex "SPA authentication"
778 .cindex "Samba project"
779 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
780 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
781 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
782 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
786 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
787 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
788 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
789 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
790 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
791 conditions expressed therein.
794 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
797 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
801 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
802 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
805 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
806 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
809 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
810 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
811 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
812 details, please contact
814 Office of Technology Transfer
815 Carnegie Mellon University
817 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
818 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
819 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
822 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
825 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
826 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
829 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
830 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
831 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
832 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
833 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
834 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
839 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
842 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
843 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
844 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
845 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
848 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
849 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
853 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
854 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
855 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
856 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
857 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
858 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
859 software without specific, written prior permission.
861 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
862 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
863 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
864 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
865 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
866 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
871 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
872 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
873 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
874 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
875 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
879 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
880 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
881 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
892 "Receiving and delivering mail"
895 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
896 .cindex "design philosophy"
897 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
898 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
899 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
900 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
901 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
902 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
905 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
906 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
907 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
908 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
909 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
910 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
911 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
914 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
915 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
916 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
917 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
918 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
919 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
920 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
921 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
922 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
925 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
926 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
929 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
930 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
931 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
934 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
935 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
936 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
937 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
940 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
941 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
944 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
945 runs at the start of every delivery process.
950 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
951 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
952 .cindex "Sieve filter"
953 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
954 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
955 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
956 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
957 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
958 of filtering are available:
961 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
964 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
965 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
968 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
972 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
973 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
974 .cindex "format" "of message id"
975 .cindex "id of message"
980 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
981 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
982 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
983 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
984 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
985 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
986 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
987 not always case-sensitive.
989 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
990 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
991 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
992 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
993 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
994 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
998 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
999 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1000 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1001 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1004 received the message.
1006 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1009 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1010 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1011 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1012 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1015 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1016 (1/100) of a second.
1020 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1021 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1022 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1023 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1024 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1027 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1028 .cindex "receiving mail"
1029 .cindex "message" "reception"
1030 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1031 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1032 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1033 there are several possibilities:
1036 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1037 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1038 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1041 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1042 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1043 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1044 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1045 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1048 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1049 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1050 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1051 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1054 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1055 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1056 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1060 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1061 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1062 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1063 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1064 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1065 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1066 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1067 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1068 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1069 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1070 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1071 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1072 users to change sender addresses.
1074 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1075 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1076 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1077 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1078 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1079 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1080 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1083 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1084 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1085 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1086 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1087 message is received.
1093 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1094 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1095 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1096 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1097 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1098 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1099 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1100 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1103 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1104 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1105 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1106 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1107 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1108 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1109 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1110 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1111 affect file system performance.
1113 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1114 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1115 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1116 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1117 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1120 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1121 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1122 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1123 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1124 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1125 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1126 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1127 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1128 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1129 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1130 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1134 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1135 .cindex "message" "life of"
1136 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1137 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1138 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1139 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1140 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1141 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1142 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1145 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1146 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1147 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1148 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1151 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1152 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1153 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1154 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1155 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1157 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1158 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1159 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1160 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1161 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1162 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1163 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1164 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1165 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1166 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1169 .cindex "journal file"
1170 .cindex "file" "journal"
1171 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1172 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1173 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1174 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1175 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1176 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1177 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1178 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1181 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1182 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1183 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1184 deliveries caused by crashes.
1188 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1189 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1190 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1192 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1193 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1194 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1195 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1196 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1199 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1200 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1201 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1202 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1203 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1204 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1205 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1206 the driver's features in general.
1208 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1209 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1210 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1211 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1214 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1215 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1216 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1217 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1218 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1219 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1222 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1223 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1224 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1225 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1226 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1229 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1230 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1233 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1234 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1235 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1236 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1237 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1238 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1239 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1240 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1241 configured to fail the address.
1243 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1244 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1245 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1246 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1247 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1248 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1251 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1252 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1253 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1254 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1255 the address is bounced.
1259 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1260 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1261 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1262 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1263 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1264 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1265 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1266 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1269 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1270 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1271 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1272 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1273 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1274 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1275 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1280 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1281 .cindex "router" "running details"
1282 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1283 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1284 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1285 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1286 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1287 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1291 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1292 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1293 original address ceases
1294 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1295 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1296 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1297 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1298 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1301 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1302 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1303 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1304 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1305 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1308 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1309 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1310 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1311 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1314 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1315 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1316 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1317 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1320 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1321 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1324 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1325 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1326 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1329 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1332 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1333 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1334 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1335 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1336 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1339 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1340 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1341 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1342 facility for this purpose.
1345 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1346 .cindex "case of local parts"
1347 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1348 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1349 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1350 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1351 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1352 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1353 routed addresses are shown.
1357 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1358 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1359 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1360 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1361 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1362 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1365 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1403 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1404 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1405 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1406 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1407 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1408 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1409 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1414 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1415 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1416 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1417 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1418 remaining preconditions.
1420 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1421 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1422 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1423 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1424 could lead to confusion.
1426 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1427 set of addresses that it defines.
1429 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1430 specified files is tested.
1432 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1433 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1434 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1435 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1439 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1440 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1441 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1442 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1443 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1444 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1445 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1449 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1450 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1451 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1454 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1455 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1456 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1457 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1458 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1460 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1461 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1463 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1464 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1465 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1466 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1467 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1468 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1471 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1472 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1473 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1474 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1475 processed entirely independently of each other.
1477 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1478 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1479 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1480 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1481 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1482 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1483 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1484 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1485 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1487 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1488 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1489 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1490 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1491 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1492 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1493 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1494 addresses to the same domain.
1496 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1497 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1498 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1499 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1500 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1501 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1502 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1503 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1505 .cindex "queue runner"
1506 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1507 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1508 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1509 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1510 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1511 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1512 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1513 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1514 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1516 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1517 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1518 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1519 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1520 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1521 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1523 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1524 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1525 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1526 messages to other addresses.
1528 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1529 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1530 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1533 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1534 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1535 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1541 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1542 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1543 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1544 .cindex "queue runner"
1545 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1546 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1547 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1548 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1549 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1550 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1551 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1552 passed its retry time.
1553 You can run several queue runners at once.
1555 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1556 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1557 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1558 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1559 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1564 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1565 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1566 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1567 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1568 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1569 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1570 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1571 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1572 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1575 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1576 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1577 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1579 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1580 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1581 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1582 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1583 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1588 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1589 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1590 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1591 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1592 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1593 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1594 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1595 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1596 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1597 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1598 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1600 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1601 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1602 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1605 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1606 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1607 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1608 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1609 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1610 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1611 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1616 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1617 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1618 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1619 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1620 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1621 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1622 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1623 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1632 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1633 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1635 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1636 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1637 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1638 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1641 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1642 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1644 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1645 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1646 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1647 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1651 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1652 following subdirectories are created:
1655 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1656 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1657 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1658 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1659 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1660 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1661 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1664 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1665 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1666 that may be useful to some sites.
1669 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1670 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1671 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1672 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1673 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1674 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1676 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1677 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1678 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1679 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1680 overridden if necessary.
1681 .cindex compiler requirements
1682 .cindex compiler version
1683 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1686 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1687 .cindex "PCRE library"
1688 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1689 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1690 install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1691 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1692 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1693 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1694 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1695 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1696 If your operating system has no
1697 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1698 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1699 More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1701 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1702 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1703 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1704 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1705 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1706 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1707 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1709 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1710 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1711 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1712 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1713 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1714 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1715 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1716 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1718 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1719 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1720 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1721 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1722 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1723 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1724 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1725 Berkeley DB library.
1727 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1728 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1732 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1733 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1735 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1736 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1737 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1738 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1739 filename is used unmodified.
1741 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1742 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1743 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1744 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1746 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1747 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1748 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1750 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1751 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1752 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1753 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1754 Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1755 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1756 page with far newer versions listed.
1757 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1758 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1759 suited to Exim's usage model.
1761 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1762 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1763 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1764 operates on a single file.
1768 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1769 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1770 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1771 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1772 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1776 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1777 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1779 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1780 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1781 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1782 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1783 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1784 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1786 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1787 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1788 in one of these lines:
1793 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1794 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1795 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1796 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1799 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1800 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1802 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1803 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1807 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1808 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1809 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1810 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1811 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1812 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1813 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1814 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1815 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1816 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1817 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1818 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1820 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1821 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1822 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1823 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1824 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1825 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1827 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1828 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1829 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1830 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1831 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1832 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1835 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1836 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1837 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1838 facilities, you need to set
1840 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1842 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1843 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1846 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1847 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1848 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1849 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1850 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1851 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1852 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1854 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1855 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1856 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1857 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1858 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1863 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1864 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1866 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1867 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1868 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1869 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1870 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1871 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1872 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1874 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1875 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1876 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1877 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1878 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1882 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1886 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1887 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1888 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1889 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1890 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1891 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1892 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1893 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1894 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1895 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1898 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1899 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1902 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1905 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1907 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1908 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1911 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1912 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1914 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1915 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1918 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1920 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1921 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1925 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1927 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1928 library and include files. For example:
1932 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1933 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1935 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1936 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1940 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1943 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1944 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1945 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1950 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1952 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1953 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1954 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1955 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1956 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1957 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1958 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1959 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1960 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1961 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1962 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1963 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1966 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1967 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1968 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1970 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1971 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1973 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1975 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1976 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1977 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1978 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1979 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1980 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1984 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1985 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1986 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1987 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1988 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1989 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1992 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1993 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1994 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1995 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1996 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1998 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2003 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2004 .cindex "lookup modules"
2005 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2006 .cindex ".so building"
2007 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2008 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2010 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2011 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2013 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2015 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2016 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2017 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2018 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2019 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2020 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2022 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2023 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2024 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2033 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2034 .cindex "build directory"
2035 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2036 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2037 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2038 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2039 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2040 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2041 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2043 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2044 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2045 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2046 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2047 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2048 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2049 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2050 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2052 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2053 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2054 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2058 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2059 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2060 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2061 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2062 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2063 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2064 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2068 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2069 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2070 given in addition to the short output.
2074 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2075 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2076 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2077 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2078 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2079 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2080 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2083 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2084 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2086 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2087 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2088 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2089 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2091 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2092 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2093 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2094 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2095 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2096 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2097 and are often not needed.
2099 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2100 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2101 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2102 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2103 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2104 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2105 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2106 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2107 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2110 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2111 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2112 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2113 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2117 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2118 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2119 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2120 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2121 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2122 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2123 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2124 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2125 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2126 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2127 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2128 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2129 containing the lines
2134 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2135 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2137 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2138 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2139 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2142 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2143 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2144 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2145 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2146 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2147 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2148 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2149 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2150 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2151 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2157 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2158 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2159 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2160 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2161 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2162 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2163 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2164 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2167 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2168 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2169 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2170 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2171 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2172 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2173 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2174 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2175 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2176 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2177 syntax. For instance:
2180 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2182 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2183 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2184 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2187 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2188 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2189 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2193 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2194 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2196 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2197 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2198 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2199 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2200 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2201 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2204 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2205 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2207 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2208 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2211 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2212 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2214 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2215 definition of all three of these variables into your
2216 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2219 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2220 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2221 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2222 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2224 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2225 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2226 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2227 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2228 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2231 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2232 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2233 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2234 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2235 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2238 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2240 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2241 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2242 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2243 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2244 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2245 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2249 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2250 .cindex "building Eximon"
2251 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2252 where the files that are involved are
2254 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2256 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2257 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2258 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2259 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2261 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2262 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2263 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2264 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2265 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2266 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2267 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2271 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2272 .cindex "installing Exim"
2273 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2274 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2275 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2276 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2277 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2278 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2279 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2280 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2281 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2282 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2283 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2284 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2286 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2287 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2288 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2289 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2290 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2291 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2292 alternative files, no default is installed.
2294 .cindex "system aliases file"
2295 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2296 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2297 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2298 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2299 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2300 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2301 and outputs a comment to the user.
2303 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2304 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2305 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2306 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2307 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2309 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2310 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2311 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2312 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2313 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2316 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2317 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2320 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2322 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2323 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2324 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2325 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2326 but this usage is deprecated.
2328 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2329 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2330 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2331 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2332 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2333 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2335 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2336 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2337 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2338 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2339 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2340 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2341 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2343 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2344 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2345 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2348 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2350 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2351 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2352 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2353 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2356 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2358 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2359 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2362 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2363 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2365 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2369 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2371 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2373 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2374 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2375 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2377 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2382 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2383 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2384 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2385 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2386 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2389 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2390 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2391 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2395 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2396 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2397 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2398 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2399 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2405 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2406 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2407 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2408 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2409 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2413 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2414 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2415 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2416 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2417 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2420 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2422 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2424 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2426 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2427 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2428 user agent. For example:
2430 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2431 From: user@your.domain.example
2432 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2433 Subject: Testing Exim
2435 This is a test message.
2438 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2439 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2440 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2442 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2443 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2444 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2445 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2446 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2447 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2449 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2451 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2452 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2453 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2454 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2455 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2457 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2458 .cindex "lock files"
2459 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2460 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2461 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2462 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2463 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2464 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2465 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2466 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2467 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2468 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2469 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2470 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2472 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2473 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2474 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2475 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2476 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2479 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2480 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2481 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2482 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2486 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2487 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2488 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2489 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2490 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2491 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2492 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2493 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2494 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2495 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2496 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2497 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2498 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2500 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2501 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2502 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2503 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2504 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2505 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2508 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2509 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2510 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2511 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2513 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2514 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2515 favourite user agent.
2517 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2518 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2519 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2520 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2521 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2522 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2526 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2527 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2528 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2529 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2530 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2531 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2532 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2533 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2534 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2535 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2541 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2542 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2543 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2545 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2547 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2548 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2549 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2550 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2551 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2553 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2555 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2557 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2558 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2559 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2564 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2565 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2567 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2568 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2569 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2570 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2571 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2572 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2573 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2574 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2575 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2578 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2580 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2581 were present before any other options.
2582 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2584 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2585 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2586 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2589 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2590 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2591 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2595 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2596 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2597 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2600 .cindex "queue runner"
2601 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2602 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2603 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2605 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2606 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2607 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2608 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2609 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2610 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2611 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2612 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2615 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2616 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2617 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2618 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2619 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2620 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2623 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2624 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2625 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2626 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2627 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2628 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2630 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2631 .cindex "envelope from"
2632 .cindex "envelope sender"
2633 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2634 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2635 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2636 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2637 users to set envelope senders.
2639 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2640 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2641 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2642 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2643 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2644 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2645 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2647 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2648 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2649 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2650 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2651 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2652 that are available to trusted users.
2654 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2655 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2656 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2657 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2658 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2660 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2661 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2662 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2663 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2665 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2666 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2667 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2668 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2670 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2671 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2676 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2677 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2678 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2684 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2685 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2686 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2687 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2688 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2689 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2690 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2691 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2693 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2694 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2695 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2696 . creates a man page for the options.
2697 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2700 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2707 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2708 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2709 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2710 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2713 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2714 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2715 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2718 .vitem &%--version%&
2719 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2720 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2727 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2730 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2732 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2733 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2734 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2735 clean; it ignores this option.
2740 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2741 .cindex "queue runner"
2742 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2743 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2744 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2746 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2747 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2748 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2749 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2751 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2752 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2753 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2754 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2756 When a listening daemon
2757 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2758 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2759 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2760 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2761 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2762 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2765 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2766 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2767 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2771 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2772 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2773 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2774 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2775 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2776 .cindex reload configuration
2777 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2778 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2779 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2780 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2781 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2782 because these are reread each time they are used.
2786 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2787 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2791 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2792 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2793 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2794 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2795 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2796 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2798 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2799 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2800 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2801 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2802 test data. A line history is supported.
2804 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2805 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2806 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2807 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2808 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2809 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2810 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2812 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2813 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2814 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2815 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2817 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2818 defined and macros will be expanded.
2819 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2820 available to admin users.
2822 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2824 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2825 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2826 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2827 of a file. For example:
2829 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2831 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2832 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2833 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2834 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2835 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2836 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2837 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2840 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2842 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2843 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2844 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2845 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2846 system filters are recognized.
2848 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2850 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2851 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2852 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2853 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2854 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2855 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2856 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2857 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2860 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2861 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2862 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2864 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2866 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2867 variables that are used by the user filter.
2869 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2874 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2875 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2876 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2879 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2880 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2881 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2882 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2884 When testing a filter file,
2885 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2886 .cindex "envelope from"
2887 .cindex "envelope sender"
2888 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2889 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2890 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2891 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2892 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2895 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2897 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2898 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2899 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2902 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2904 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2905 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2906 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2907 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2908 actually being delivered.
2910 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2912 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2913 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2914 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2917 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2919 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2920 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2921 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2924 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2926 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2927 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2928 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2929 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2930 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2931 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2932 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2933 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2934 after a full stop. For example:
2936 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2937 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2939 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2940 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2941 conversion to the canonical form is
2942 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2944 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2945 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2946 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2947 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2948 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2952 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2953 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2954 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2957 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2958 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2959 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2961 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2962 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2963 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2964 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2965 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2966 session were authenticated.
2968 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2969 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2970 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2972 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2973 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2974 specialized SMTP test program such as
2975 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2977 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2979 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2980 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2981 updating the callout cache database.
2985 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2986 .cindex "building alias file"
2987 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2988 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2989 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2990 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2991 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2994 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2995 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2996 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2997 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2998 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2999 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3002 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3004 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3005 .cindex "querying exim information"
3006 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3007 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3008 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3009 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3010 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3013 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3014 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3015 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3016 recognised DSCP names.
3018 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3019 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3020 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3021 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3022 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3023 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3024 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3025 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3026 way to guarantee a correct response.
3030 .cindex "local message reception"
3031 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3032 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3033 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3034 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3035 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3036 if no other conflicting option is present.
3038 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3039 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3040 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3041 suppressing this for special cases.
3043 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3044 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3046 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3047 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3048 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3051 .cindex "message" "format"
3052 .cindex "format" "message"
3053 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3054 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3055 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3056 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3057 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3059 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3060 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3062 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3063 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3064 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3065 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3066 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3068 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3069 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3070 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3071 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3072 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3074 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3075 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3076 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3077 .cindex "malware scan test"
3078 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3079 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3080 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3081 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3082 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3083 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3084 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3086 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3087 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3088 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3089 This option requires admin privileges.
3091 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3092 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3093 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3097 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3098 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3099 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3100 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3101 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3102 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3103 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3105 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3106 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3107 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3108 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3109 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3111 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3112 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3113 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3114 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3119 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3120 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3121 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3122 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3123 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3124 arguments, for example:
3126 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3128 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3129 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3130 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3131 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3132 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3133 users, the output is as in this example:
3135 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3137 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3138 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3140 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3141 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3142 backward compatibility.)
3143 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3144 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3146 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3147 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3148 name will not be output.
3150 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3151 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3152 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3153 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3154 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3155 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3156 written directly into the spool directory.
3158 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3160 exim -bP +local_domains
3162 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3163 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3165 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3166 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3167 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3168 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3169 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3170 that driver are output. For example:
3172 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3174 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3175 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3176 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3177 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3178 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3181 .cindex "environment"
3182 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3183 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3186 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3187 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3188 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3189 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3190 The output format is one item per line.
3191 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3192 the exit status will be nonzero.
3196 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3197 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3198 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3199 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3200 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3201 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3202 to allow any user to see the queue.
3204 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3206 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3207 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3210 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3211 .cindex "size" "of message"
3212 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3213 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3214 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3215 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3216 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3217 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3218 before the sender address.
3220 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3221 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3222 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3224 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3225 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3226 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3227 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3228 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3234 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3235 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3236 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3242 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3243 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3244 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3245 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3250 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3251 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3252 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3253 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3257 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3261 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3266 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3267 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3268 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3269 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3274 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3275 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3276 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3277 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3278 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3280 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3281 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3283 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3284 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3285 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3286 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3287 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3288 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3289 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3290 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3291 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3293 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3294 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3299 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3300 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3301 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3302 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3303 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3304 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3305 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3309 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3310 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3311 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3312 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3313 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3314 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3315 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3316 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3317 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3319 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3320 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3321 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3323 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3324 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3325 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3326 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3328 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3329 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3330 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3332 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3333 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3334 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3335 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3336 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3338 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3339 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3343 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3344 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3345 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3346 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3347 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3348 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3349 messages to the MTA.
3352 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3353 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3354 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3355 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3356 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3357 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3358 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3362 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3363 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3364 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3365 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3366 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3367 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3368 the listening daemon.
3372 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3373 .cindex "address" "testing"
3374 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3375 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3376 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3377 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3378 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3380 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3381 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3383 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3384 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3387 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3388 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3389 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3390 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3391 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3394 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3395 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3396 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3397 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3399 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3400 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3401 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3402 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3405 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3406 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3408 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3409 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3410 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3411 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3412 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3413 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3418 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3419 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3420 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3421 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3422 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3423 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3425 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3426 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3427 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3428 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3429 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3430 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3431 dynamic testing facilities.
3435 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3436 .cindex "address" "verification"
3437 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3438 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3439 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3440 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3441 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3442 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3444 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3445 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3446 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3448 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3449 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3451 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3452 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3455 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3456 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3457 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3458 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3459 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3461 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3462 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3463 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3464 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3465 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3466 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3469 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3470 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3471 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3474 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3475 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3476 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3477 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3479 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3480 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3481 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3482 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3486 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3487 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3494 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3495 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3496 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3497 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3499 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3500 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3501 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3502 each port only when the first connection is received.
3504 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3505 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3507 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3509 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3510 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3511 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3512 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3513 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3514 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3515 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3516 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3517 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3519 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3520 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3521 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3522 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3523 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3524 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3525 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3526 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3527 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3529 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3530 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3531 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3532 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3533 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3534 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3535 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3537 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3538 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3539 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3540 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3541 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3542 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3543 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3545 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3546 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3547 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3550 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3551 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3552 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3553 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3554 specified by this option.
3557 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3559 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3560 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3561 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3562 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3563 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3564 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3566 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3567 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3568 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3569 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3570 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3571 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3572 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3574 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3575 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3576 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3582 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3583 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3586 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3588 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3589 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3592 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3594 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3595 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3596 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3597 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3598 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3599 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3600 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3603 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3604 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3605 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3606 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3607 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3608 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3609 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3612 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3613 &`auth `& authenticators
3614 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3615 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3616 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3617 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3618 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3619 &`filter `& filter handling
3620 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3621 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3622 &`ident `& ident lookup
3623 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3624 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3625 &`load `& system load checks
3626 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3627 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3628 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3629 &`memory `& memory handling
3630 &`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3631 &`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3632 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3633 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3634 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3635 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3636 &`retry `& retry handling
3637 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3638 &`route `& address routing
3639 &`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3641 &`transport `& transports
3642 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3643 &`verify `& address verification logic
3644 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3646 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3647 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3648 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3649 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3650 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3651 turn everything off.
3653 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3654 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3655 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3656 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3657 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3660 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3661 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3662 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3663 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3664 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3667 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3668 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3671 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3672 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3673 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3674 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3675 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3676 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3678 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3679 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3681 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3683 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3684 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3685 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3686 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3689 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3690 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3691 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3692 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3696 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3697 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3698 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3699 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3700 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3701 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3702 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3703 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3706 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3707 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3708 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3709 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3710 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3712 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3714 .cindex "sender" "name"
3715 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3716 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3717 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3718 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3719 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3720 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3722 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3724 .cindex "sender" "address"
3725 .cindex "address" "sender"
3726 .cindex "trusted users"
3727 .cindex "envelope from"
3728 .cindex "envelope sender"
3729 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3730 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3731 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3732 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3735 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3736 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3737 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3738 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3741 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3742 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3743 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3744 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3745 examples of shell commands:
3747 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3748 exim -f "" user@domain
3750 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3751 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3754 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3755 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3756 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3757 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3760 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3761 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3762 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3763 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3764 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3765 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3769 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3770 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3772 control = suppress_local_fixups
3774 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3775 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3778 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3781 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3783 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3784 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3785 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3790 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3791 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3792 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3793 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3794 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3795 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3797 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3799 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3800 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3801 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3802 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3803 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3804 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3806 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3808 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3810 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3811 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3812 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3813 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3814 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3815 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3816 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3819 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3820 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3821 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3822 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3823 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3824 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3826 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3827 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3828 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3829 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3831 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3833 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3834 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3835 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3836 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3837 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3838 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3839 can be used only by an admin user.
3841 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3842 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3844 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3845 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3846 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3847 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3848 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3849 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3850 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3851 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3855 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3856 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3857 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3861 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3862 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3863 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3865 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3867 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3868 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3869 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3873 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3874 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3875 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3879 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3880 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3881 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3883 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3885 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3886 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3887 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3888 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3889 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3890 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3894 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3895 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3896 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3901 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3902 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3903 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3905 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3907 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3908 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3909 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3910 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3912 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3914 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3915 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3916 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3917 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3918 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3919 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3920 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3921 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3922 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3923 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3924 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3925 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3926 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3928 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3930 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3931 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3932 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3933 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3934 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3935 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3936 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3937 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3939 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3941 .cindex "freezing messages"
3942 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3943 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3944 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3945 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3946 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3947 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3950 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3952 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3953 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3954 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3955 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3956 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3957 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3958 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3959 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3962 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3964 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3965 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3966 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3967 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3968 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3970 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3972 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3973 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3974 .cindex "removing recipients"
3975 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3976 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3977 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3978 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3979 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3980 can be used only by an admin user.
3982 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3984 .cindex "removing messages"
3985 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3986 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3987 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3988 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3989 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3990 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3991 placed in the queue.
3996 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
3997 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
3998 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4002 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4004 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4005 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4006 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4007 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4008 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4009 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4010 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4011 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4012 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4014 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4016 .cindex "thawing messages"
4017 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4018 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4019 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4020 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4021 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4022 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4025 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4027 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4028 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4029 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4030 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4032 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4034 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4035 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4036 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4037 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4038 only by an admin user.
4040 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4042 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4043 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4044 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4045 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4046 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4048 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4050 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4051 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4052 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4053 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4057 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4058 treats it that way too.
4062 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4063 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4064 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4065 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4066 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4067 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4068 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4071 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4072 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4073 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4074 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4075 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4076 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4077 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4082 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4083 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4084 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4085 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4087 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4089 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4092 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4094 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4095 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4096 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4099 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4101 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4102 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4103 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4104 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4105 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4106 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4110 .cindex "background delivery"
4111 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4112 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4113 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4114 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4115 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4116 processes to finish.
4118 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4119 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4120 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4121 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4123 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4124 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4125 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4126 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4130 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4131 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4132 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4133 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4134 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4135 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4137 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4138 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4141 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4142 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4144 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4145 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4146 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4147 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4152 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4157 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4158 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4159 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4160 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4161 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4162 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4163 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4164 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4165 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4166 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4171 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4172 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4173 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4174 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4175 configuration file is in effect.
4177 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4178 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4179 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4180 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4181 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4182 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4183 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4184 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4185 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4190 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4191 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4192 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4195 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4197 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4198 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4199 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4200 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4204 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4205 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4206 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4207 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4208 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4212 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4213 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4214 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4215 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4216 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4220 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4221 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4226 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4227 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4232 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4233 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4234 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4235 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4236 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4237 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4240 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4241 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4243 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4245 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4246 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4247 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4248 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4249 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4250 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4252 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4253 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4255 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4257 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4258 followed by a colon and the port number:
4260 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4262 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4263 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4264 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4265 whichever one is last.
4267 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4269 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4270 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4271 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4272 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4273 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4274 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4276 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4278 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4279 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4280 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4281 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4282 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4283 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4285 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4287 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4288 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4289 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4290 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4291 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4292 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4293 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4294 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4296 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4298 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4299 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4300 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4301 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4302 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4304 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4306 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4307 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4308 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4309 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4310 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4311 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4312 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4314 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4315 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4316 is sending the bounce.
4318 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4320 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4321 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4322 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4323 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4324 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4325 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4326 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4327 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4328 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4329 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4331 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4333 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4334 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4335 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4336 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4337 uses the name it is given.
4339 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4341 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4342 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4343 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4344 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4345 used, when there is no default.
4349 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4350 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4351 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4352 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4356 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4357 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4358 whatever that means.
4360 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4362 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4363 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4364 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4365 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4366 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4367 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4368 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4370 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4372 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4373 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4374 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4375 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4376 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4378 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4380 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4381 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4382 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4383 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4384 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4385 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4389 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4391 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4393 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4394 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4395 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4396 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4397 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4398 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4399 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4400 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4404 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4405 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4406 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4407 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4412 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4413 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4414 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4415 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4418 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4420 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4422 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4424 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4425 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4426 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4427 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4428 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4429 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4433 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4434 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4435 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4436 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4437 and &%-S%& options).
4439 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4440 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4441 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4442 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4443 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4444 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4445 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4448 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4449 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4450 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4451 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4452 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4455 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4456 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4457 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4458 this to be repeated periodically.
4460 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4461 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4462 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4463 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4465 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4466 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4467 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4469 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4470 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4471 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4472 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4476 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4477 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4478 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4479 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4480 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4481 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4484 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4485 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4486 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4487 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4488 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4489 delivered down a single SMTP
4490 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4491 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4492 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4493 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4494 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4497 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4499 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4500 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4501 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4502 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4503 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4505 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4507 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4508 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4509 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4510 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4511 their retry times are tried.
4513 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4515 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4516 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4519 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4521 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4522 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4523 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4526 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4529 .cindex "named queues"
4530 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4531 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4532 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4533 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4534 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4535 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4537 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4538 will specify a queue to operate on.
4541 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4543 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4546 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4547 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4548 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4549 starting message id. For example:
4551 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4553 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4554 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4555 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4557 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4559 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4560 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4561 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4562 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4563 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4564 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4566 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4567 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4568 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4569 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4570 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4571 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4572 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4573 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4574 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4576 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4578 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4579 process every 30 minutes.
4581 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4582 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4584 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4586 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4589 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4591 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4593 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4595 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4596 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4597 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4598 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4599 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4600 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4601 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4603 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4604 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4605 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4606 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4607 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4608 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4610 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4611 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4613 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4615 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4616 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4617 applied to each queue run.
4619 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4620 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4621 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4622 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4623 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4624 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4625 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4626 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4627 address will be skipped.
4629 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4630 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4631 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4634 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4635 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4636 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4637 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4638 an arbitrary command instead.
4642 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4644 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4646 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4647 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4648 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4649 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4650 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4651 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4653 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4655 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4656 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4657 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4661 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4662 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4663 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4664 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4665 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4666 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4667 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4668 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4669 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4671 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4672 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4673 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4674 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4675 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4676 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4677 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4678 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4679 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4680 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4681 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4683 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4684 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4685 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4686 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4687 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4688 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4690 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4691 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4692 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4693 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4694 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4695 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4696 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4697 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4698 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4702 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4703 compatibility with Sendmail.
4705 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4706 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4707 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4708 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4709 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4710 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4711 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4712 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4717 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4718 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4719 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4720 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4721 set. Exim ignores this option.
4725 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4726 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4727 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4728 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4729 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4730 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4735 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4736 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4737 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4740 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4742 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4743 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4745 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4747 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4748 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4749 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4757 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4758 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4759 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4760 . creates a man page for the options.
4761 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4764 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4771 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4772 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4775 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4776 "The runtime configuration file"
4778 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4779 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4780 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4781 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4782 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4783 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4784 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4785 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4786 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4789 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4790 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4791 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4792 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4793 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4794 actually alter the string.
4796 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4797 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4798 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4799 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4800 existing file in the list.
4803 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4804 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4805 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4806 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4807 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4808 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4809 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4810 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4811 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4812 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4814 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4815 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4816 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4817 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4818 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4820 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4821 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4822 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4823 compromise the Exim user account.
4825 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4826 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4827 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4828 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4829 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4830 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4835 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4836 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4837 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4838 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4839 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4840 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4841 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4842 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4843 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4844 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4845 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4847 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4848 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4849 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4850 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4851 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4852 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4853 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4854 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4855 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4858 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4859 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4860 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4861 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4862 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4864 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4865 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4866 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4867 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4868 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4869 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4871 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4872 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4873 necessarily be discarded.
4874 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4875 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4876 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4877 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4878 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4879 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4881 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4882 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4883 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4884 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4885 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4886 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4887 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4889 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4890 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4891 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4895 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4896 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4897 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4898 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4899 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4900 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4901 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4902 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4905 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4908 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4909 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4910 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4912 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4913 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4914 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4916 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4917 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4918 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4920 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4921 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4922 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4923 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4926 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4927 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4928 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4930 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4931 want to use this feature, you must set
4933 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4935 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4936 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4939 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4940 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4941 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4942 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4944 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4945 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4946 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4947 and does not introduce a comment.
4949 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4950 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4951 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4952 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4953 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4955 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4956 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4957 change settings as required.
4959 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4960 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4961 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4962 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4963 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4968 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4969 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4970 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4971 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4972 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4973 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
4976 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
4977 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
4979 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
4980 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4981 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4982 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4983 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
4986 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4987 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4988 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4989 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4991 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4992 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4995 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4998 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4999 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5004 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5005 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5006 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5007 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5008 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5009 definition, and must be of the form
5011 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5013 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5014 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5015 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5016 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5017 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5019 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5020 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5021 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5023 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5024 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5025 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5026 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5027 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5028 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5029 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5032 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5033 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5035 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5036 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5037 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5038 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5039 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5040 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5043 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5044 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5045 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5050 MAC == updated value
5052 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5053 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5054 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5055 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5059 MAC == MAC and something added
5061 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5062 from a number of other files.
5064 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5065 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5066 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5067 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5068 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5073 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5074 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5075 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5076 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5078 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5079 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5081 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5083 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5085 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5086 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5087 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5090 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5091 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5092 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5093 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5094 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5097 The following classes of macros are defined:
5099 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5100 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5101 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5102 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5103 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5104 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5105 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5106 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5107 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5108 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5109 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5110 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5113 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5116 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5117 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5118 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5119 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5120 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5121 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5122 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5124 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5125 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5126 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5130 message_size_limit = 50M
5132 message_size_limit = 100M
5135 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5136 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5137 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5138 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5139 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5141 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5142 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5143 in this line"& will always be true.
5145 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5146 to clarify complicated nestings.
5150 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5151 .cindex "common option syntax"
5152 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5153 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5154 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5155 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5156 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5157 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5158 space) and then the value. For example:
5160 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5162 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5163 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5164 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5165 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5166 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5167 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5168 word &"hide"&. For example:
5170 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5172 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5174 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5176 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5177 all instances of the same driver.
5179 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5180 that are found in option settings.
5183 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5184 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5185 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5186 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5187 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5188 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5189 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5190 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5191 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5192 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5193 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5194 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5199 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5204 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5209 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5210 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5211 .cindex "format" "integer"
5212 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5213 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5214 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5215 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5218 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5219 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5220 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5222 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5223 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5224 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5228 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5229 .cindex "integer format"
5230 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5231 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5232 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5233 Such options are always output in octal.
5236 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5237 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5238 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5239 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5240 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5244 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5245 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5246 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5247 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5248 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5258 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5259 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5260 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5264 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5265 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5266 .cindex "format" "string"
5267 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5268 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5269 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5270 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5271 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5272 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5273 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5274 therefore equivalent:
5276 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5277 trusted_users = uucp:\
5278 # This comment line is ignored
5281 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5282 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5283 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5284 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5285 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5288 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5289 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5290 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5292 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5293 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5297 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5298 character, that character replaces the pair.
5300 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5301 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5302 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5303 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5304 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5305 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5308 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5309 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5310 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5311 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5312 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5313 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5314 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5315 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5316 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5317 within a quoted configuration string.
5320 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5321 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5322 .cindex "format" "user name"
5323 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5324 .cindex "format" "group name"
5325 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5326 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5327 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5328 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5331 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5332 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5333 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5334 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5335 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5336 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5337 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5338 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5339 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5340 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5341 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5343 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5344 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5345 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5346 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5347 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5348 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5351 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5353 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5355 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5356 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5357 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5358 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5360 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5361 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5362 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5363 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5364 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5365 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5366 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5367 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5369 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5371 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5372 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5373 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5375 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5376 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5377 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5378 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5379 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5380 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5381 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5382 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5383 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5385 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5387 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5388 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5389 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5390 the value in quotes. For example:
5392 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5394 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5395 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5396 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5397 enclosing an empty list item.
5401 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5402 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5403 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5404 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5406 senders = user@domain :
5408 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5409 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5410 items, the second of which is empty:
5412 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5414 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5415 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5416 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5417 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5421 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5422 is at the end of the list.
5427 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5428 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5429 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5430 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5431 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5432 a sequence of lines like this:
5434 <&'instance name'&>:
5439 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5440 followed by three options settings:
5445 transport = local_delivery
5447 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5448 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5449 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5450 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5451 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5452 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5454 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5455 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5457 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5458 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5459 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5460 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5461 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5464 .cindex "generic options"
5465 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5466 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5467 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5468 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5469 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5470 .cindex "private options"
5471 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5472 they all have default values.
5474 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5475 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5476 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5478 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5479 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5480 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5481 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5482 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5483 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5484 configuration lines:
5489 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5490 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5491 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5492 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5498 command_timeout = 10s
5500 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5501 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5504 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5505 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5506 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5514 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5515 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5517 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5518 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5519 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5520 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5521 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5522 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5523 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5524 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5525 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5526 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5527 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5531 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5532 All macros should be defined before any options.
5534 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5536 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5538 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5539 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5540 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5541 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5543 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5544 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5545 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5548 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5549 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5550 in the file, after the macros.
5551 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5553 # primary_hostname =
5555 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5556 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5557 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5558 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5560 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5562 domainlist local_domains = @
5563 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5564 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5566 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5567 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5568 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5569 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5571 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5572 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5575 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5576 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5577 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5578 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5579 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5580 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5582 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5583 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5584 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5585 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5586 domain is permitted.
5588 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5589 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5590 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5591 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5592 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5593 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5595 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5596 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5597 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5599 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5601 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5602 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5604 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5605 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5606 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5607 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5608 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5609 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5610 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5611 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5612 contents of a message to be checked.
5614 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5616 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5617 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5619 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5620 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5621 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5622 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5624 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5626 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5627 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5628 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5630 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5631 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5632 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5633 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5634 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5635 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5636 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5638 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5640 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5641 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5643 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5644 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5645 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5646 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5647 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5648 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5649 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5650 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5651 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5652 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5653 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5654 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5655 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5656 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5657 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5658 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5660 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5661 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5662 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5663 which should be used in preference to 587.
5664 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5666 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5668 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5671 # qualify_recipient =
5673 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5674 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5675 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5676 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5677 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5678 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5680 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5681 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5682 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5683 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5685 # allow_domain_literals
5687 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5688 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5689 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5690 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5691 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5692 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5694 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5698 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5699 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5700 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5701 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5702 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5703 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5704 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5705 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5707 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5708 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5713 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5714 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5715 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5716 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5717 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5718 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5721 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5722 1413 (hence their names):
5725 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5727 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5728 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5729 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5730 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5731 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5732 information, you can change this.
5734 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5735 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5740 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5741 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5742 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5743 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5745 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5746 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5748 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5749 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5751 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5754 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5755 +tls_certificate_verified
5758 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5760 # percent_hack_domains =
5762 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5763 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5764 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5766 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5767 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5768 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5769 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5770 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5771 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5772 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5773 always bounce messages.
5775 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5776 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5778 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5779 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5780 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5781 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5782 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5784 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5785 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5786 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5787 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5788 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5791 # split_spool_directory = true
5794 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5795 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5796 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5797 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5798 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5799 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5800 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5802 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5805 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5806 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5807 that are not 8-bit clean.
5809 # accept_8bitmime = false
5812 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5813 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5814 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5815 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5816 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5817 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5819 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5820 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5824 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5825 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5826 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5827 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5828 It starts with the line
5832 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5833 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5834 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5836 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5837 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5838 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5839 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5840 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5841 result of the ACL processing.
5845 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5850 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5851 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5852 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5853 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5854 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5855 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5857 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5858 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5859 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5862 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5863 domains = +local_domains
5864 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5866 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5867 domains = !+local_domains
5868 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5870 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5871 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5872 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5873 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5874 in Internet mail addresses.
5876 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5877 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5878 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5879 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5880 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5881 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5882 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5883 policy of being as safe as possible.
5885 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5886 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5887 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5888 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5889 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5890 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5892 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5893 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5894 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5895 have to modify this rule.
5897 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5898 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5899 common convention of local parts constructed as
5900 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5901 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5902 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5903 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5904 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5905 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5907 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5908 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5909 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5910 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5911 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5912 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5913 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5915 accept local_parts = postmaster
5916 domains = +local_domains
5918 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5919 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5920 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5921 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5922 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5924 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5925 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5926 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5928 require verify = sender
5930 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5931 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5932 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5933 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5934 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5935 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5936 discusses the details of address verification.
5938 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5939 control = submission
5941 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5942 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5943 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5944 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5945 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5946 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5947 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5948 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5949 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5951 accept authenticated = *
5952 control = submission
5954 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5955 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5956 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5957 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5958 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5959 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5961 require message = relay not permitted
5962 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5964 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5965 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5967 require verify = recipient
5969 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5970 fails, the address is rejected.
5972 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5973 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5975 # dnslists = black.list.example
5977 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5978 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5979 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5980 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5982 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5983 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5984 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5987 # require verify = csa
5989 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5990 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5995 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5996 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6000 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6001 of this ACL are commented out:
6004 # message = This message contains a virus \
6007 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6008 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6009 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6010 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6012 # warn spam = nobody
6013 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6014 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6015 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6016 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6018 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6019 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6020 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6021 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6022 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6023 whatever the spam score.
6027 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6030 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6031 .cindex "default" "routers"
6032 .cindex "routers" "default"
6033 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6038 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6039 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6040 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6041 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6042 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6045 # driver = ipliteral
6046 # domains = !+local_domains
6047 # transport = remote_smtp
6049 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6050 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6051 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6052 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6053 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6055 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6056 macro has been defined, per
6058 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6067 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6068 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6069 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6070 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6074 driver = manualroute
6075 domains = ! +local_domains
6076 transport = smarthost_smtp
6077 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6078 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6081 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6082 specified by the line
6084 domains = ! +local_domains
6086 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6087 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6088 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6089 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6090 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6091 passed on to the following routers.
6093 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6094 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6095 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6096 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6098 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6099 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6100 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6101 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6102 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6103 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6104 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6109 domains = ! +local_domains
6110 transport = remote_smtp
6111 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6113 dnssec_request_domains = *
6117 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6119 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6120 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6121 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6122 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6123 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6125 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6126 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6127 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6128 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6129 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6130 the address fails and is bounced.
6132 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6133 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6134 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6135 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6136 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6137 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6138 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6145 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6147 file_transport = address_file
6148 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6150 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6151 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6152 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6153 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6154 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6157 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6158 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6159 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6160 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6165 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6166 # local_part_suffix_optional
6167 file = $home/.forward
6172 file_transport = address_file
6173 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6174 reply_transport = address_reply
6176 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6177 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6178 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6179 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6180 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6183 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6184 # local_part_suffix_optional
6186 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6187 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6188 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6189 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6190 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6191 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6192 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6194 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6195 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6196 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6197 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6199 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6200 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6201 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6202 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6203 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6204 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6205 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6207 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6208 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6209 There are two reasons for doing this:
6212 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6213 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6216 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6217 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6218 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6219 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6223 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6224 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6225 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6226 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6228 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6229 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6230 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6232 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6234 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6240 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6241 # local_part_suffix_optional
6242 transport = local_delivery
6244 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6245 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6246 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6247 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6248 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6251 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6252 .cindex "default" "transports"
6253 .cindex "transports" "default"
6254 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6255 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6256 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6260 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6264 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6272 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6273 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6274 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6275 with over-long lines. The built-in macro _HAVE_DANE guards configuration
6276 to use DANE for delivery;
6277 see section &<<SECDANE>>& for more details.
6279 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6280 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6281 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6282 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6284 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6285 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6286 usual federated system.
6291 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6295 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6296 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6297 hosts_require_tls = *
6298 tls_verify_hosts = *
6299 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6300 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6302 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6304 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6305 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6306 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6307 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6308 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6309 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6311 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6312 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6315 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6322 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6323 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6324 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6325 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6326 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6327 then no other options are defined.
6328 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6329 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6330 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6331 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6332 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6333 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6334 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6335 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6336 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6337 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6338 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6340 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6342 All other options are defaulted.
6346 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6353 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6354 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6355 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6356 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6357 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6358 show how this can be done.
6360 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6361 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6362 similarly-named options above.
6368 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6369 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6370 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6371 be returned to the sender.
6379 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6380 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6381 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6386 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6391 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6392 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6393 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6394 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6395 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6396 introduced by the line
6400 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6403 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6405 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6406 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6407 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6408 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6409 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6411 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6412 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6413 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6416 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6417 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6421 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6422 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6426 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6427 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6428 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6430 begin authenticators
6432 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6433 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6434 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6435 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6436 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6437 to support most MUA software.
6439 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6442 # driver = plaintext
6443 # server_set_id = $auth2
6444 # server_prompts = :
6445 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6446 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6448 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6451 # driver = plaintext
6452 # server_set_id = $auth1
6453 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6454 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6455 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6458 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6459 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6460 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6461 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6462 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6463 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6464 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6465 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6467 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6468 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6469 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6470 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6472 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6473 usercode and password are in different positions.
6474 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6476 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6480 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6483 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6485 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6487 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6488 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6489 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6490 regular expressions is discussed in
6491 online Perl manpages, in
6492 many Perl reference books, and also in
6493 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6494 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6495 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6496 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6497 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6499 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6500 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6501 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6502 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6503 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6506 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6507 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6508 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6509 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6511 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6513 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6514 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6515 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6516 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6517 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6518 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6521 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6522 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6523 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6524 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6525 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6526 match anywhere in the subject string.
6528 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6529 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6531 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6533 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6536 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6538 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6539 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6543 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6544 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6546 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6547 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6548 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6549 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6550 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6551 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6554 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6555 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6556 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6557 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6558 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6559 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6561 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6562 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6563 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6564 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6565 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6566 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6569 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6570 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6571 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6572 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6573 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6574 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6576 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6577 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6578 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6579 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6580 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6582 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6583 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6585 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6586 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6587 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6588 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6589 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6591 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6592 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6594 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6595 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6597 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6598 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6599 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6604 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6605 matches the list item.
6607 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6608 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6610 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6612 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6613 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6614 causes a second lookup to occur.
6616 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6617 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6618 lookup is permitted.
6621 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6622 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6623 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6624 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6627 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6628 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6629 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6631 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6632 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6633 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6634 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6637 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6638 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6639 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6644 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6645 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6646 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6651 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6652 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6653 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6654 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6657 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6658 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6659 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6660 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6661 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6662 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6663 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6664 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6665 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6667 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6668 &url(http://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6669 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6670 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6672 . --- 2018-09-07: corpit.ru http:-only
6673 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6674 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6675 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6676 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6678 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6679 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6680 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6681 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6682 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6683 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6684 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6686 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6687 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6688 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6689 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6690 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6691 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6692 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6694 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6695 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6697 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6698 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6699 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6700 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6701 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6702 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6703 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6705 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6706 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6707 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6709 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6710 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6711 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6712 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6713 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6714 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6715 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6716 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6717 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6718 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6720 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6721 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6722 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6723 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6724 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6725 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6726 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6727 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6728 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6730 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6731 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6732 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6733 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6734 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6735 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6736 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6738 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6739 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6740 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6741 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6743 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6744 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6745 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6746 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6747 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6749 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6750 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6751 lookup types support only literal keys.
6753 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6754 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6755 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6758 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6759 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6760 notation before executing the lookup.)
6765 .cindex json "lookup type"
6766 .cindex JSON expansions
6767 &(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6768 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6769 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6770 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6771 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6772 of the JSON structure.
6773 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6774 nunbered array element is selected.
6775 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6776 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6777 or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6779 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6782 .cindex "linear search"
6783 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6784 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6785 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6786 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6787 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6788 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6789 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6790 in the file is used.
6792 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6793 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6794 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6795 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6796 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6801 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6802 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6803 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6804 wildcarding of any kind.
6806 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6807 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6808 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6809 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6810 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6811 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6812 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6813 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6814 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6817 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6818 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6819 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6820 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6821 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6822 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6823 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6824 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6827 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6828 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6829 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6830 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6831 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6832 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6833 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6834 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6835 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6837 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6838 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6839 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6840 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6842 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6843 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6846 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6848 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6849 *fish data for anythingfish
6852 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6853 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6855 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6857 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6858 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6859 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6861 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6863 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6864 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6865 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6867 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6870 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6871 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6872 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6873 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6874 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6876 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6877 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6878 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6879 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6880 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6883 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6884 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6885 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6888 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6890 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6893 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6894 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6895 be followed by optional colons.
6897 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6898 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6899 lookup types support only literal keys.
6902 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
6903 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6904 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6905 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6909 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6910 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6911 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6912 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6913 many of them are given in later sections.
6916 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6917 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6918 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6919 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6920 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6922 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6923 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6924 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6926 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6927 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6928 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6929 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6930 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6931 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6932 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6934 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6935 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6936 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6937 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6939 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6940 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6941 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6942 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6944 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6945 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6946 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6947 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6949 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6950 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6951 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6952 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6953 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6954 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6955 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6956 password value. For example:
6958 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6961 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6962 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6963 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6964 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6967 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6968 .cindex lookup Redis
6969 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6970 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6973 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6974 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6975 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
6976 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6979 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6980 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6982 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6983 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6984 . --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6985 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6986 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6987 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6988 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6989 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6990 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6991 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6993 require condition = \
6994 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6996 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6997 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6998 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6999 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7004 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7005 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7006 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7007 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7008 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7009 options such as a list of local domains.
7011 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7012 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7013 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7014 or may give up altogether.
7018 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7019 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7020 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7021 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7022 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7023 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7024 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7025 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7027 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7028 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7029 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7031 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7032 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7033 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7035 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7036 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7037 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7038 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7039 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7040 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7041 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7042 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7043 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7044 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7046 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7048 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7049 looks up these keys, in this order:
7055 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7056 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7057 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7058 Exim move on to try the next key.
7062 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7063 .cindex "partial matching"
7064 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7065 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7066 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7067 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7068 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7069 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7070 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7071 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7072 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7073 a key in a DBM file is
7075 *.dates.fict.example
7077 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7078 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7079 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7082 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7083 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7084 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7086 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7087 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7088 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7089 partial matching keys
7090 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7091 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7092 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7094 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7095 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7096 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7097 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7098 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7099 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7102 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7103 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7104 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7105 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7106 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7107 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7109 2250.dates.fict.example
7110 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7111 *.dates.fict.example
7114 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7117 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7118 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7119 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7120 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7121 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7122 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7124 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7126 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7127 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7128 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7129 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7131 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7133 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7134 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7136 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7137 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7138 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7141 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7143 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7144 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7146 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7147 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7148 for &"*"& on its own.
7150 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7154 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7155 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7156 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7157 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7158 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7159 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7160 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7162 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7163 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7164 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7165 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7166 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7171 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7172 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7173 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7174 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7175 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7176 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7177 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7179 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7180 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7181 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7182 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7183 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7184 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7186 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7187 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7193 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7194 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7195 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7196 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7197 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7198 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7202 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7203 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7205 [name="$local_part"]
7207 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7208 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7209 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7210 of the following form is provided:
7212 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7214 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7216 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7218 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7219 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7220 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7225 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7226 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7227 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7228 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7229 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7230 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7231 an expansion string could contain:
7233 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7235 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7236 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7237 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7238 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7240 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7241 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7242 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7244 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7245 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7246 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7247 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7248 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7250 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7252 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7253 white space is ignored.
7254 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7255 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7256 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7258 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7259 When the type is PTR,
7260 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7261 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7263 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7265 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7266 altered and nothing is added.
7268 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7269 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7270 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7271 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7272 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7273 The field separator can be modified as above.
7275 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7276 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7277 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7278 unless a field separator is specified.
7279 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7281 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7283 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7284 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7285 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7287 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7288 white space is ignored.
7290 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7291 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7292 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7293 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7296 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7299 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7300 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7301 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7302 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7303 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7304 each followed by a comma,
7305 that may appear before the record type.
7307 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7308 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7309 a defer-option modifier.
7310 The possible keywords are
7311 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7312 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7313 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7314 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7315 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7316 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7317 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7319 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7320 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7322 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7323 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7325 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7326 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7327 The possible keywords are
7328 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7329 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7331 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7332 is not labelled as authenticated data
7333 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7334 The default is &"never"&.
7336 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7338 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7339 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7340 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7341 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7343 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7345 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7346 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7347 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7349 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7350 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7352 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7353 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7354 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7357 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7358 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7359 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7360 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7361 the pseudo-type MXH:
7363 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7365 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7368 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7369 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7370 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7371 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7372 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7373 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7374 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7375 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7377 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7378 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7380 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7381 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7382 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7384 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7385 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7386 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7387 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7388 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7391 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7392 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7393 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7394 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7395 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7396 result of a successful lookup such as:
7398 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7400 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7401 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7402 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7404 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7405 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7406 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7407 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7409 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7413 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7414 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7415 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7416 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7417 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7419 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7420 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7421 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7423 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7424 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7425 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7426 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7428 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7429 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7430 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7435 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7436 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7437 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7438 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7439 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7440 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7441 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7442 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7443 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7444 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7445 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7446 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7448 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7449 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7450 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7451 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7452 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7454 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7455 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7457 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7458 the way they handle the results of a query:
7461 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7464 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7465 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7467 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7468 from all of them are returned.
7472 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7473 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7474 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7475 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7478 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7479 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7480 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7481 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7483 data = ${lookup ldap \
7484 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7485 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7487 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7488 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7489 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7490 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7492 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7493 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7494 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7496 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7497 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7498 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7499 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7500 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7501 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7502 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7503 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7507 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7508 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7509 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7510 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7511 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7512 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7514 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7515 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7523 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7524 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7528 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7530 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7534 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7536 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7538 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7540 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7541 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7542 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7546 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7547 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7548 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7550 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7554 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7556 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7558 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7560 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7561 authentication below.
7564 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7565 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7566 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7567 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7568 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7571 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7573 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7574 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7575 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7576 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7577 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7578 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7579 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7580 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7581 failures, and timeouts.
7583 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7584 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7585 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7586 doubled. For example
7588 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7590 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7591 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7592 the local host) is used.
7594 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7595 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7596 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7597 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7600 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7601 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7602 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7603 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7605 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7607 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7608 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7610 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7612 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7613 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7614 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7615 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7616 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7617 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7618 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7621 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7622 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7623 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7626 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7629 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7633 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7634 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7638 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7639 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7640 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7641 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7642 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7643 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7644 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7645 them. The following names are recognized:
7647 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7648 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7649 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7650 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7651 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7652 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7653 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7654 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7656 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7657 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7658 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7659 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7661 .cindex LDAP timeout
7662 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7663 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7664 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7665 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7666 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7667 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7668 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7669 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7670 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7671 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7673 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7674 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7676 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7677 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7678 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7679 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7680 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7681 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7682 alternate list (colon-separated).
7684 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7685 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7688 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7689 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7692 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7693 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7694 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7695 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7697 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7698 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7699 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7701 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7702 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7703 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7704 quoting has two advantages:
7707 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7708 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7710 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7713 For example, a setting such as
7715 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7717 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7719 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7720 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7721 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7722 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7726 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7727 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7732 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7733 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7734 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7735 as a sequence of values, for example
7737 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7739 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7740 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7741 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7742 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7743 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7746 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7747 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7748 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7749 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7751 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7752 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7753 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7754 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7755 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7756 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7757 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7758 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7759 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7761 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7762 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7763 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7764 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7765 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7768 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7771 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7774 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7775 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7777 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7778 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7780 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7781 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7784 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7785 results of LDAP lookups.
7786 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7787 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7788 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7789 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7790 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7791 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7796 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7797 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7798 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7799 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7800 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7801 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7802 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7803 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7805 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7807 might return the string
7809 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7810 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7812 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7814 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7820 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7821 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7822 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7826 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7827 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7828 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7829 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7830 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7831 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7832 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7833 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7834 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7835 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7836 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7837 .cindex lookup Redis
7838 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7840 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7843 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7846 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7847 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7849 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7854 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7856 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7857 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7858 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7862 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7863 with a newline between the data for each row.
7866 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7867 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7868 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7869 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7870 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7871 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7872 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7873 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7874 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7875 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7876 .cindex lookup Redis
7877 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7878 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7879 or &%redis_servers%&
7880 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7882 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7883 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7884 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7886 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7887 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7888 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7889 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7891 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7893 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7894 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7895 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7897 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7898 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7900 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7901 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7902 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7903 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7904 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7905 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7907 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7908 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7909 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7911 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7912 host, database number, and password.
7914 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7915 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7916 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7918 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7920 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7923 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7924 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7925 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7926 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7928 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7929 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7931 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7932 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7933 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7934 done by starting the query with
7936 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7938 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7940 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7941 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7942 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7945 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7947 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7948 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7949 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7951 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7952 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7953 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7956 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7960 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7962 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7964 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7965 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7966 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7968 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7972 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7973 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7974 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7975 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7976 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7977 the default value is &"exim"&.
7978 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7980 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7981 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7983 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7984 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7986 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7989 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7990 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7992 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7993 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7994 is zero because no rows are affected.
7997 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7998 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7999 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8000 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8001 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8004 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8006 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8007 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8008 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8010 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8011 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8014 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8015 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8016 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8017 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8018 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8019 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8020 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8021 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8022 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8024 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8025 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8027 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8029 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8030 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8032 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8033 quote, which it doubles.
8035 .cindex timeout SQLite
8036 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8037 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8038 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8039 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8040 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8041 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8042 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8045 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8046 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8047 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8048 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8051 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8052 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8055 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8056 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8057 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8058 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8061 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8062 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8063 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8070 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8071 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8073 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8074 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8075 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8076 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8077 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8078 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8079 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8080 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8081 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8083 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8084 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8085 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8086 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8088 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8089 support all the complexity available in
8090 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8094 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8095 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8096 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8098 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8099 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8102 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8103 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8104 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8105 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8106 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8109 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8110 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8111 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8113 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8114 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8115 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8116 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8117 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8119 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8120 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8122 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8123 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8124 senders based on the receiving domain.
8129 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8130 .cindex "list" "negation"
8131 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8132 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8133 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8134 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8135 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8136 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8138 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8139 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8140 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8141 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8142 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8144 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8146 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8147 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8148 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8150 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8152 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8153 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8154 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8156 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8157 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8162 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8163 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8164 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8165 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8166 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8167 filenames are not allowed,
8168 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8169 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8173 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8174 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8176 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8177 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8178 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8180 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8184 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8185 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8186 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8187 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8189 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8190 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8192 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8194 and the file contains the lines
8199 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8200 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8204 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8205 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8206 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8207 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8208 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8209 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8210 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8211 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8213 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8214 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8215 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8216 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8221 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8222 .cindex "named lists"
8223 .cindex "list" "named"
8224 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8225 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8226 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8227 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8228 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8229 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8230 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8232 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8234 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8235 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8236 configured with the line
8238 domains = +local_domains
8240 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8241 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8245 domains = ! +local_domains
8246 transport = remote_smtp
8249 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8250 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8251 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8252 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8254 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8255 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8257 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8259 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8260 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8261 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8263 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8264 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8265 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8267 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8268 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8270 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8271 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8272 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8274 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8276 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8277 referenced lists if you can.
8279 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8280 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8281 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8283 domains = +local_domains
8285 on several of your routers
8286 or in several ACL statements,
8287 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8288 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8289 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8290 the same each time they are referenced.
8292 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8293 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8294 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8295 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8299 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8300 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8301 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8302 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8303 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8306 ALIST = host1 : host2
8307 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8309 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8311 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8313 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8316 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8317 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8319 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8321 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8325 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8326 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8327 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8328 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8329 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8330 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8331 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8332 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8333 message. For example:
8335 domainlist special_domains = \
8336 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8338 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8339 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8340 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8341 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8342 same list each time.
8344 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8345 cache the result anyway. For example:
8347 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8349 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8350 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8354 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8355 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8356 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8357 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8358 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8361 .cindex "primary host name"
8362 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8363 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8364 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8365 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8366 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8367 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8368 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8369 differ only in their names.
8371 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8372 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8373 .cindex "domain literal"
8374 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8375 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8376 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8377 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8378 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8379 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8382 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8383 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8384 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8385 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8386 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8387 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8388 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8389 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8390 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8391 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8392 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8394 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8395 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8396 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8397 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8398 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8400 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8401 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8402 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8403 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8404 on a router). For example:
8406 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8408 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8409 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8411 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8412 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8413 contain negative items.
8415 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8416 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8417 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8419 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8420 an.other.domain : ...
8422 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8423 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8425 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8426 an.other.domain ? ...
8429 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8430 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8431 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8432 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8433 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8434 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8435 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8436 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8437 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8441 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8442 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8443 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8444 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8445 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8446 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8447 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8448 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8449 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8451 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8452 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8453 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8454 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8455 expression by expansion, of course).
8457 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8458 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8459 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8460 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8461 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8462 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8464 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8466 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8467 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8468 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8469 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8470 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8471 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8472 other statements in the same ACL.
8475 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8476 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8478 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8480 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8481 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8484 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8485 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8486 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8487 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8488 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8489 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8492 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8493 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8494 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8495 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8497 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8498 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8500 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8501 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8502 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8503 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8504 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8506 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8507 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8508 between the pattern and the domain.
8511 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8513 domainlist funny_domains = \
8516 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8517 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8518 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8519 nis;domains.byname : \
8520 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8522 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8523 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8524 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8525 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8526 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8531 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8532 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8533 .cindex "list" "host list"
8534 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8535 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8536 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8537 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8538 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8539 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8540 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8543 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8544 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8545 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8546 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8547 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8548 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8551 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8552 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8553 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8557 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8558 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8559 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8560 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8561 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8562 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8563 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8566 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8567 inspecting its IP address:
8570 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8571 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8572 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8573 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8574 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8575 with the IP address of the subject host.
8577 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8578 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8579 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8580 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8581 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8584 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8585 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8586 domain name, as just described.
8589 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8590 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8591 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8592 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8593 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8594 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8595 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8596 that can never match a client host.
8599 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8600 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8601 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8602 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8604 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8608 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8609 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8610 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8611 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8612 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8613 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8614 significant end of the address.
8616 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8617 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8618 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8619 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8623 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8624 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8627 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8629 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8630 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8632 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8633 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8636 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8638 could make use of a file containing
8643 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8644 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8645 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8647 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8650 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8656 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8657 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8658 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8659 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8660 address, the pattern takes this form:
8662 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8666 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8668 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8669 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8670 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8671 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8672 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8673 returned by the lookup is not used.
8675 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8676 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8677 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8678 patterns of this form:
8680 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8684 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8686 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8687 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8688 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8689 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8690 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8692 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8693 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8694 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8695 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8696 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8697 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8698 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8699 converted using colons and not dots.
8701 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8702 addresses are always used.
8703 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8706 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8707 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8708 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8711 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8712 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8713 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8714 case the IP address is used on its own.
8718 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8719 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8720 .cindex "unknown host name"
8721 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8722 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8723 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8724 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8725 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8728 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8729 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8730 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8731 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8732 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8733 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8734 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8736 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8737 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8739 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8740 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8741 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8742 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8743 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8744 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8745 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8746 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8747 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8749 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8750 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8752 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8753 .cindex "alias for host"
8754 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8755 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8758 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8759 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8760 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8761 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8762 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8765 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8766 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8767 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8768 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8769 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8770 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8771 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8776 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8777 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8778 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8779 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8780 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8782 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8784 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8785 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8786 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8793 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8794 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8795 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8796 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8797 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8798 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8800 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8801 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8803 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8804 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8805 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8806 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8807 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8808 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8809 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8810 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8811 not recognized in an indirected file).
8814 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8815 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8817 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8819 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8820 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8823 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8824 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8827 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8830 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8831 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8832 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8835 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8836 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8839 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8841 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8843 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8844 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8845 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8848 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8849 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8850 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8852 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8854 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8855 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8856 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8857 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8858 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8859 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8860 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8863 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8864 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8866 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8867 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8869 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8870 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8871 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8876 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8878 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8879 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8880 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8881 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8882 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8883 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8884 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8885 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8886 host lists such as whitelists.
8890 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8891 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8892 .cindex "unknown host name"
8893 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8894 If a pattern is of the form
8896 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8900 dbm;/host/accept/list
8902 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8903 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8906 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8907 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8908 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8909 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8910 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8911 lookup, both using the same file.
8915 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8916 If a pattern is of the form
8918 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8920 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8921 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8922 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8924 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8925 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8927 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8928 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8929 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8932 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8933 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8934 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8936 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8937 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8938 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8939 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8940 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8941 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8947 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8948 .cindex "list" "address list"
8949 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8950 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8951 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8952 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8953 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8954 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8955 using this option setting:
8959 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8960 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8961 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8962 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8964 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8967 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8969 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8970 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8971 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8972 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8973 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8974 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8975 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8977 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8978 *@+hostile_domains:\
8979 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8980 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8982 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8983 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8984 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8985 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8986 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8988 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8989 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8990 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8991 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8992 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8994 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8997 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8998 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9002 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9003 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9004 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9005 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9006 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9007 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9008 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9010 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9011 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9013 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9014 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9017 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9018 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9019 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9022 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9023 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9024 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9026 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9027 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9028 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9029 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9031 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9032 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9034 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9035 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9036 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9037 default. For example, with this lookup:
9039 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9041 the file could contains lines like this:
9043 user1@domain1.example
9046 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9049 nimrod@jaeger.example
9053 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9054 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9056 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9058 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9059 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9061 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9062 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9063 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9067 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9068 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9073 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9074 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9075 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9076 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9077 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9078 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9079 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9080 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9081 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9083 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9084 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9085 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9086 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9087 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9090 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9092 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9094 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9096 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9098 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9099 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9100 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9101 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9102 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9103 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9105 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9108 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9111 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9112 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9113 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9114 might have entries like
9116 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9117 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9120 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9121 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9122 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9123 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9125 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9126 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9127 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9130 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9131 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9132 can only return a single list of local parts.
9135 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9136 in these two examples:
9139 senders = *@+my_list
9141 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9142 example it is a named domain list.
9147 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9148 .cindex "case of local parts"
9149 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9150 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9151 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9152 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9153 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9154 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9155 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9156 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9159 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9160 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9161 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9162 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9163 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9164 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9165 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9168 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9169 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9170 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9171 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9172 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9173 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9174 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9175 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9179 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9180 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9181 .cindex "local part" "list"
9182 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9183 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9184 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9185 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9186 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9187 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9188 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9189 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9191 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9192 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9193 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9194 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9195 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9196 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9197 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9199 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9204 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9205 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9207 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9208 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9209 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9210 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9212 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9213 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9214 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9215 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9216 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9217 escape character, as described in the following section.
9219 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9220 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9221 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9222 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9223 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9226 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9227 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9228 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9234 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9235 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9236 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9237 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9238 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9239 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9240 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9241 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9243 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9244 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9245 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9246 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9248 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9250 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9251 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9256 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9257 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9258 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9259 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9260 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9261 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9262 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9265 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9266 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9267 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9270 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9271 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9272 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9274 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9275 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9276 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9277 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9278 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9279 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9280 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9283 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9284 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9285 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9288 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9289 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9290 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9291 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9293 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9295 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9296 Exim message identifier. For example:
9298 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9300 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9301 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9304 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9305 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9306 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9307 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9308 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9309 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9310 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9311 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9312 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9313 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9314 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9315 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9321 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9322 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9323 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9324 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9325 white space is significant.
9328 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9329 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9330 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9335 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9336 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9337 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9338 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9339 given, the expansion fails.
9341 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9342 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9343 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9344 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9348 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9349 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9350 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9351 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9352 string easier to understand.
9354 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9355 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9356 expansion item below.
9359 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9360 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9361 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9362 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9363 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9364 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9365 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9366 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9367 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9368 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9369 the result of the expansion.
9370 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9371 the expansion result is an empty string.
9372 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9375 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9376 .cindex authentication "results header"
9377 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9378 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9379 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9380 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9382 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9383 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9384 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9393 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9395 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9397 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9400 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9401 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9402 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9403 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9404 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9405 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9406 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9407 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9411 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9412 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9417 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9421 If the field is found,
9422 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9423 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9424 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9425 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9427 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9428 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9431 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9433 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9434 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9436 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9437 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9438 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9439 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9440 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9441 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9442 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9443 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9445 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9446 take an optional modifier of "int"
9447 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9448 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9449 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9451 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9452 newline-separated by default,
9453 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9454 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9455 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9457 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9458 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9459 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9460 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9461 if so the element tags are omitted.
9463 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9465 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9466 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9468 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9469 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9473 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9474 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9475 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9477 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9478 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9479 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9480 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9481 must have the following type:
9483 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9485 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9486 function should return one of the following values:
9488 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9489 into the expanded string that is being built.
9491 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9492 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9494 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9495 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9497 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9499 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9500 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9501 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9504 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9505 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9506 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9507 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9509 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9510 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9511 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9513 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9514 appear, for example:
9516 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9518 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9519 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9521 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9523 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9526 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9527 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9530 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9531 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9532 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9533 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9534 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9535 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9536 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9537 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9539 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9542 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9543 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9544 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9545 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9546 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9547 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9548 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9549 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9550 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9552 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9553 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9554 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9557 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9558 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9560 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9561 appear, for example:
9563 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9565 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9566 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9568 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9569 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9570 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9571 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9572 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9573 .cindex JSON expansions
9574 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9575 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9576 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9577 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9579 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9582 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9583 the spaces are optional.
9584 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9585 For the &"json"& variant,
9586 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9589 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9590 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9592 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9594 The results of matching are handled as above.
9597 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9598 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9599 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9600 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9601 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9602 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9603 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9604 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9605 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9606 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9607 <&'string3'&> as before.
9609 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9610 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9611 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9612 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9613 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9614 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9615 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9616 provided. For example:
9618 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9622 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9624 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9625 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9628 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9629 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9630 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9631 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9632 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9633 .cindex JSON expansions
9634 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9635 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9637 Field selection and result handling is as above;
9638 there is no choice of field separator.
9639 For the &"json"& variant,
9640 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9643 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9644 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9648 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9649 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9650 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9652 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9653 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9655 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9656 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9657 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9658 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9659 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9661 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9663 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9664 to what it was before. See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
9667 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9668 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9669 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9670 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9671 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9672 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9674 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9675 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9676 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9677 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9679 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9681 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9682 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9683 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9684 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9685 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9687 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9689 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9690 letters appear. For example:
9692 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9693 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9694 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9697 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9698 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9699 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9700 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9701 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9702 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9703 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9704 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9705 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9706 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9707 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9708 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9709 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9710 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9711 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9712 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9713 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9717 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9718 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9719 lines) may be present.
9721 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9722 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9725 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9726 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9727 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9730 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9731 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9732 are multiple headers with a given name.
9733 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9734 list-processing facilities can be used.
9735 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9736 the content is &"raw"&.
9739 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9740 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9741 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9742 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9743 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9744 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9745 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9746 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9749 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9750 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9751 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9752 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9753 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9754 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9757 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9758 command of the following form:
9760 headers charset "UTF-8"
9762 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9763 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9764 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9765 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9766 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9769 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9770 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9771 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9772 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9774 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9775 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9776 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9777 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9778 router or transport are not accessible.
9780 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9781 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9782 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9783 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9784 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9785 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9786 point they are added.
9787 When any of the above ACLs ar
9788 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9790 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9791 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9792 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9793 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9794 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9795 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9796 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9799 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9800 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9801 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9802 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9803 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9804 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9805 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9806 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9809 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9810 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9812 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9813 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9814 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9815 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9816 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9817 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9818 present. For example:
9820 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9822 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9825 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9827 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9828 an Exim configuration:
9830 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9832 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9835 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9836 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9837 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9839 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9840 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9841 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9842 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9843 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9844 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9847 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9848 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9849 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9850 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9851 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9852 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9854 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9856 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9857 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9858 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9859 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9860 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9862 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9863 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9864 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9866 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9870 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9875 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9876 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9877 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9878 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9879 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9880 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9884 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9885 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9886 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9887 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9888 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9889 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9890 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9893 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9895 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9896 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9897 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9898 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9901 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9902 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9903 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9904 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9905 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9906 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9907 apart from an optional leading minus,
9908 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9910 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9911 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9913 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9914 If the number is negative, the fields are
9915 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9916 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9917 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9919 If the modulus of the
9920 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9921 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9925 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9929 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9931 yields &"result: 42"&.
9933 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9934 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9936 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9939 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9940 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9941 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9942 described in the next item.
9944 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9945 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9946 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9947 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9948 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9949 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9950 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9951 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9952 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9954 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9955 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9956 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9957 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9958 out by the system administrator.
9961 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9962 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9963 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9964 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9965 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9966 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9967 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9968 original lookup fails.
9970 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9971 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9972 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9973 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9974 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9975 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9976 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9977 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9979 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9980 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9981 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9982 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9984 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9985 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9986 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9987 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9989 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9991 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9993 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9994 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9996 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10001 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10002 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10004 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10005 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10007 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10008 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10009 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10010 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10012 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10014 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10015 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10016 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10018 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10019 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10020 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10021 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10022 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10023 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10024 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10026 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10028 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10029 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10030 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10031 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10034 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10036 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10040 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10041 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10042 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10043 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10044 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10045 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10046 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10047 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10049 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10050 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10051 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10052 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10053 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10056 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10057 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10058 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10060 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10061 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10064 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10065 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10066 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10067 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10068 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10069 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10070 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10071 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10073 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10074 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10075 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10076 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10077 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10078 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10079 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10080 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10081 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10082 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10084 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10085 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10086 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10087 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10089 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10090 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10091 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10092 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10093 is the expansion of the third argument.
10095 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10096 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10097 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10099 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10100 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10101 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10102 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10103 The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10104 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10105 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10106 newlines are left in the string.
10107 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10108 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10109 the string expansion fails.
10111 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10112 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10116 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10117 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10118 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10119 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10120 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10121 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10122 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10125 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10126 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10128 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10129 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10130 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10131 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10132 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10135 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10137 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10138 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10139 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10140 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10141 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10142 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10143 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10145 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10148 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10149 and must be present if the argument is given.
10150 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10151 Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10152 The first defines whether (the default)
10153 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10154 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10156 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10158 The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10160 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10162 The default is to not use TLS.
10163 If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10165 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10166 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10167 turns them into spaces:
10169 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10171 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10172 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10173 addition, the following errors can occur:
10176 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10178 Failure to connect the socket;
10180 Failure to write the request string;
10182 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10185 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10186 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10187 errors occurs. For example:
10189 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10192 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10193 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10194 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10195 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10196 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10198 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10199 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10202 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10203 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10204 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10205 .vindex "&$value$&"
10207 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10208 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10209 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10210 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10211 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10212 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10213 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10214 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10215 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10216 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10218 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10220 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10223 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10225 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10226 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10229 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10230 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10231 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10233 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10234 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10235 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10236 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10237 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10238 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10239 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10240 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10241 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10243 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10244 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10245 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10246 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10247 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10248 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10249 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10250 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10251 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10254 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10255 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10256 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10257 .vindex "&$value$&"
10258 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10259 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10260 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10261 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10262 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10265 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10266 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10267 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10268 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10270 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10271 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10272 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10275 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10276 log_message = Output of id: $value
10278 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10279 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10281 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10284 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10285 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10286 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10288 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10289 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10293 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10294 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10297 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10298 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10299 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10300 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10302 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10303 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10306 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10307 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10308 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10309 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10310 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10311 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10312 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10313 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10315 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10317 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10318 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10319 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10321 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10323 yields &"defabc"&, and
10325 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10327 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10328 the regular expression from string expansion.
10330 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10331 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10334 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10335 .cindex sorting "a list"
10336 .cindex list sorting
10337 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10338 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10339 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10340 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10341 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10342 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10343 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10344 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10345 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10346 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10347 to give values for comparison.
10349 The item result is a sorted list,
10350 with the original list separator,
10351 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10355 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10357 sorts a list of numbers, and
10359 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10361 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10364 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10365 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10366 .cindex "substring extraction"
10367 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10368 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10369 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10370 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10371 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10373 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10375 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10376 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10379 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10380 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10381 length required. For example
10383 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10385 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10386 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10387 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10388 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10390 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10391 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10392 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10394 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10396 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10397 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10398 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10400 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10402 yields an empty string, but
10404 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10408 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10409 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10410 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10411 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10414 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10416 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10418 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10422 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10423 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10424 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10425 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10426 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10427 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10428 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10429 replacement list. For example
10431 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10433 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10434 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10435 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10438 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10444 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10445 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10446 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10447 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10448 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10449 following operations can be performed:
10452 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10453 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10454 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10455 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10456 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10457 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10459 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10462 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10463 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10464 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10465 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10466 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10467 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10468 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10469 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10470 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10472 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10473 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10474 character. For example:
10476 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10478 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10479 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10480 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10481 separator explicitly:
10483 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10486 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10487 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10488 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10491 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10492 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10493 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10494 email address separator. For the example header line:
10496 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10498 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10499 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10500 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10501 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10502 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10503 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10504 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10506 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10507 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10509 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10510 Last:user@example.com
10511 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10513 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10517 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10518 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10519 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10520 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10521 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10522 Only lowercase letters are used.
10524 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10525 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10526 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10527 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10528 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10530 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10531 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10532 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10533 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10534 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10535 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10536 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10537 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10538 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10540 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10541 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10542 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10543 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10544 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10545 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10548 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10549 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10550 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10551 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10552 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10553 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10555 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10556 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10559 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10560 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10561 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10562 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10563 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10566 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10567 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10568 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10569 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10570 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10573 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10574 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10575 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10576 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10577 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10578 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10579 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10581 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10582 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10583 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10584 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10585 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10586 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10589 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10590 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10591 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10592 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10593 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10594 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10595 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10596 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10597 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10598 C programming language):
10600 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10601 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10602 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10603 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10604 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10606 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10608 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10609 space is permitted before or after operators.
10611 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10612 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10613 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10614 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10615 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10617 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10619 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10620 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10623 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10624 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10625 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10626 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10627 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10628 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10629 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10630 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10631 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10632 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10633 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10636 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10638 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10641 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10644 {$recipients_count} \
10645 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10649 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10650 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10653 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10654 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10655 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10658 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10660 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10661 and then re-expands what it has found.
10664 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10666 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10667 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10668 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10669 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10670 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10671 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10672 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10673 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10674 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10676 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10677 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10678 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10679 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10680 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10681 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10682 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10685 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10686 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10687 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10688 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10689 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10690 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10692 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10694 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10695 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10699 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10700 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10701 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10702 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10703 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10704 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10708 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10709 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10710 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10711 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10712 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10713 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10714 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10717 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10718 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10719 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10720 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10721 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10722 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10723 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10725 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10726 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10727 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10728 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10729 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10730 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10731 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10732 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10733 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10736 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10737 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10738 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10739 .cindex "lower casing"
10740 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10741 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10742 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10746 Case is defined per the system C locale.
10748 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10749 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10750 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10751 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10752 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10753 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10755 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10757 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10758 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10759 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10760 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10763 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10764 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10765 .cindex "list" "item count"
10766 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10767 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10768 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10771 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10772 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10773 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10774 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10775 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10776 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10777 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10778 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10779 matching list is returned.
10782 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10783 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10784 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10785 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10786 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10788 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10791 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10792 .cindex "masked IP address"
10793 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10794 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10795 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10796 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10797 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10798 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10799 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10800 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10801 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10803 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10805 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10806 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10807 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10808 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10810 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10814 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10816 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10819 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10821 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10822 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10823 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10824 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10825 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10827 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10828 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10831 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10832 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10833 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10834 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10835 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10836 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10838 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10840 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10843 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10844 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10845 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10846 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10847 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10848 is an empty string or
10849 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10850 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10851 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10852 respectively For example,
10860 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10861 variable or a message header.
10863 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10864 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10865 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10866 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10867 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10868 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10869 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10871 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10872 will likely use the quoting form.
10873 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10876 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10877 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10878 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10879 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10880 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10882 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10888 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10889 yields an unchanged string.
10892 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10893 .cindex "random number"
10894 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10895 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10896 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10897 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10898 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10899 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10900 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10901 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10905 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10906 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10907 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10908 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10909 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10910 for DNS. For example,
10912 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10913 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10918 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10922 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10923 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10924 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10925 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10926 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10927 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10928 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10929 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10930 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10933 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10935 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10936 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10940 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10941 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10942 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10943 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10944 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10945 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10946 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10947 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10949 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10950 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10951 to use this operator as well.
10955 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10956 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10957 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10958 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10959 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10960 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10961 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10964 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10965 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10966 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10967 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10968 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10969 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10970 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10972 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10973 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10976 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10977 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10978 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10979 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10980 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
10981 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10982 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10983 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10984 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10985 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10987 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10989 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10990 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10993 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
10994 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
10995 Finally, if an underbar
10996 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
10997 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
10998 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11002 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11003 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11004 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11005 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11006 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11007 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11009 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11011 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11012 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11013 with 256 being the default.
11015 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11016 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11017 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11018 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11021 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11022 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11023 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11024 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11025 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11026 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11027 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11028 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11029 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11030 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11031 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11032 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11033 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11035 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11036 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11037 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11039 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11040 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11041 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11045 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11046 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11047 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11048 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11049 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11050 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11051 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11054 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11055 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11056 .cindex "substring extraction"
11057 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11058 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11059 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11060 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11062 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11064 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11065 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11066 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11068 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11069 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11070 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11071 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11074 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11075 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11076 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11077 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11078 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11079 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11082 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11083 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11084 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11085 .cindex "upper casing"
11086 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11087 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11088 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11089 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11091 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11092 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11093 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11094 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11095 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11096 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11097 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11098 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11099 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11100 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11101 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11102 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11103 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11104 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11106 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11108 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11109 literal question mark).
11111 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11112 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11113 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11114 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11115 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11116 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11118 .cindex internationalisation
11119 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11120 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11121 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11122 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11123 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11124 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11132 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11133 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11134 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11135 while expanding strings:
11138 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11139 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11140 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11141 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11144 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11145 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11146 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11147 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11153 &`>= `& greater or equal
11155 &`<= `& less or equal
11159 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11161 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11162 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11163 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11164 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11165 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11168 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11169 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11170 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11173 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11174 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11175 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11176 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11177 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11178 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11179 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11180 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11181 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11182 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11183 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11184 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11185 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11186 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11188 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11189 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11190 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11191 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11192 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11193 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11195 An empty string is treated as false.
11196 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11197 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11198 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11200 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11201 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11204 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11208 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11209 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11210 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11211 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11212 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11213 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11214 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11215 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11217 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11219 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11220 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11221 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11222 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11223 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11224 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11225 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11226 included in the binary.
11228 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11229 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11230 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11231 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11232 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11233 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11234 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11235 string in LDAP form is:
11237 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11239 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11240 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11242 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11244 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11249 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11250 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11251 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11252 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11253 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11254 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11258 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11259 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11260 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11261 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11262 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11263 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11266 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11267 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11268 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11269 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11270 whatever its length.
11273 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11274 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11275 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11276 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11278 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11279 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11280 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11281 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11282 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11283 support &[crypt16()]&.
11285 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11286 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11287 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11288 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11289 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11291 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11292 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11293 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11295 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11296 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11297 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11298 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11299 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11301 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11302 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11303 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11304 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11305 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11306 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11308 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11310 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11311 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11313 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11314 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11315 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11316 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11317 exists in the message. For example,
11319 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11321 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11322 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11324 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11325 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11326 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11327 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11328 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11329 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11330 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11331 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11332 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11333 case is defined per the system C locale.
11335 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11336 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11337 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11338 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11339 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11340 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11341 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11342 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11344 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11345 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11346 .cindex "first delivery"
11347 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11348 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11349 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11350 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11353 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11354 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11355 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11356 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11357 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11359 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11360 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11361 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11362 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11363 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11364 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11366 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11367 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11368 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11370 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11371 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11372 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11374 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11375 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11376 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11377 list separator is changed to a comma:
11379 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11381 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11382 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11384 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11387 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11388 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11389 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11390 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11391 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11392 .cindex JSON expansions
11393 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11394 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11395 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11396 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11397 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11399 The array separator is not changeable.
11400 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11401 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11406 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11407 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11408 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11409 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11410 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11411 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11412 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11413 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11414 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11416 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11418 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11419 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11420 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11421 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11422 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11423 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11424 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11425 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11426 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11428 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11430 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11431 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11432 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11433 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11434 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11435 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11437 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11439 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11440 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11442 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11443 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11444 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11445 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11448 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11449 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11450 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11451 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11452 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11453 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11454 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11455 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11456 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11457 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11458 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11460 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11461 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11462 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11463 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11464 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11466 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11467 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11469 This is no longer the case.
11471 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11472 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11474 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11476 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11478 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11479 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11480 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11481 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11482 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11483 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11484 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11485 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11486 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11487 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11488 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11489 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11490 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11494 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11495 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11496 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11497 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11498 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11499 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11500 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11501 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11502 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11504 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11506 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11507 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11508 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11509 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11510 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11511 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11512 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11513 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11514 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11516 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11519 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11520 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11521 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11522 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11523 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11524 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11525 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11526 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11527 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11528 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11529 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11532 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11534 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11535 backslashes is also required.
11537 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11538 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11539 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11540 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11541 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11542 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11543 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11544 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11546 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11547 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11548 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11549 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11550 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11551 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11552 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11553 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11555 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11556 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11557 See &*match_local_part*&.
11559 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11560 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11561 See &*match_local_part*&.
11563 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11564 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11565 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11566 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11567 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11568 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11570 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11572 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11575 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11577 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11579 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11580 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11581 in a single test such as
11582 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11583 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11584 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11585 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11587 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11589 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11591 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11593 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11594 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11595 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11596 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11597 masks. For example:
11599 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11601 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11602 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11603 address mask, for example:
11605 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11607 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11608 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11610 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11614 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11615 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11617 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11619 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11620 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11621 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11622 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11623 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11624 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11625 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11626 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11629 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11631 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11632 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11633 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11634 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11636 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11638 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11639 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11640 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11641 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11644 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11645 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11647 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11648 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11649 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11650 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11652 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11653 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11654 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11655 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11656 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11657 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11658 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11659 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11660 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11661 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11662 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11666 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11667 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11669 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11670 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11671 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11672 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11673 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11674 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11675 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11677 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11678 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11679 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11680 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11681 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11683 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11685 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11687 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11689 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11690 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11691 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11692 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11695 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11696 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11698 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11699 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11700 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11701 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11702 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11703 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11705 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11706 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11707 building Exim. For example:
11709 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11711 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11712 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11713 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11714 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11716 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11717 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11718 configuration, you might have this:
11720 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11722 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11724 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11726 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11727 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11728 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11729 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11730 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11731 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11734 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11736 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11737 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11738 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11739 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11740 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11743 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11744 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11745 this library, you need to set
11747 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11749 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11750 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11752 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11754 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11755 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11756 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11758 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11759 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11760 the authentication is successful. For example:
11762 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11766 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11767 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11768 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11770 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11771 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11772 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11773 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11774 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11775 by a process that is not running as root.
11777 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11778 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11779 building Exim. For example:
11781 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11783 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11784 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11785 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11787 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11788 two are mandatory. For example:
11790 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11792 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11793 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11794 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11799 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11800 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11801 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11802 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11803 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11804 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11805 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11809 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11810 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11811 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11812 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11813 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11816 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11818 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11819 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11820 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11822 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11823 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11824 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11825 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11826 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11827 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11828 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11829 parsed but not evaluated.
11831 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11836 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11837 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11838 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11839 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11840 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11843 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11844 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11845 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11846 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11847 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11848 In the expansion condition case
11849 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11850 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11851 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11852 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11853 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11854 matching condition.
11856 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11857 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11858 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11859 any unused variables being made empty.
11861 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11862 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11863 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11864 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11865 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11866 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11867 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11868 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11869 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11870 during subsequent delivery.
11872 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11873 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11874 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11875 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11876 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11877 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11878 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11879 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11882 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11883 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11884 this variable has the number of arguments.
11886 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11887 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11888 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11889 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11890 be preserved by coding like this:
11892 warn !verify = sender
11893 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11895 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11896 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11899 .vitem &$address_data$&
11900 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11901 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11902 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11903 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11904 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11905 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11908 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11909 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11910 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11911 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11912 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11913 from the child's routing.
11915 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11916 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11917 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11920 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11921 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11922 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11924 .vitem &$address_file$&
11925 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11926 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11927 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11928 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11929 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11931 /home/r2d2/savemail
11933 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11934 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11935 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11936 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11937 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11938 to the relevant file.
11940 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11941 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11942 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11943 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11945 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11946 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11947 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11948 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11950 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11951 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11952 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11953 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11954 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11955 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11956 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11957 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11958 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11960 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11961 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11962 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11963 command line option.
11964 This second case also sets up information used by the
11965 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11967 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11968 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11969 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11970 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11971 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11972 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11973 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11974 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11975 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11979 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11980 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11981 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11982 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11983 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11984 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11985 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11986 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11987 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11988 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11989 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11991 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11992 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11993 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11994 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11995 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11998 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11999 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12000 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12001 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12002 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12003 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12004 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12005 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12006 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
12007 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12008 an undefined mechanism.
12010 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12011 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12012 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12013 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12014 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12015 the ACL malware condition.
12017 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12018 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12019 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12020 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12021 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12022 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12024 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12025 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12026 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12027 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12028 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12029 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12030 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12032 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12033 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12034 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12035 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12036 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12038 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12039 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12040 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12041 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12042 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12044 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12045 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12046 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12047 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12048 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12049 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12050 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12052 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12053 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12054 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12055 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12056 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12057 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12058 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12060 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12061 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12062 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12063 address that was connected to.
12065 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12066 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12067 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12068 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12069 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12071 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12072 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12073 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12074 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12075 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12076 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12078 .vitem &$config_file$&
12079 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12080 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12083 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12084 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12085 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12086 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12087 Results of DMARC verification.
12088 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12091 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12092 Results of DKIM verification.
12093 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12095 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12096 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12097 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12098 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12099 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12101 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12102 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12103 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12104 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12105 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12106 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12107 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12108 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12109 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12110 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12111 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12112 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12113 &$dkim_key_length$&
12114 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12115 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12117 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12118 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12119 When a message has been received this variable contains
12120 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12121 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12123 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12124 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12125 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12127 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12128 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12129 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12130 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12131 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12132 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12133 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12134 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12135 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12138 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12139 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12140 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12141 case for &$domain$&.
12143 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12144 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12145 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12146 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12148 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12149 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12150 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12151 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12152 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12153 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12155 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12156 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12157 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12159 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12162 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12163 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12164 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12165 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12166 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12167 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12168 the &(smtp)& transport.
12171 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12172 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12173 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12174 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12177 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12178 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12179 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12180 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12181 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12182 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12185 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12186 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12187 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12188 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12192 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12193 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12194 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12195 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12196 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12197 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12198 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12201 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12202 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12203 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12206 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12207 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12208 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12210 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12211 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12212 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12214 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12215 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12216 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12218 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12219 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12220 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12221 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12222 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12223 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12224 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12226 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12227 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12228 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12229 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12230 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12231 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12233 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12234 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12235 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12236 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12237 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12241 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12242 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12243 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12244 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12245 by a setting on the transport itself.
12247 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12248 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12249 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12253 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12254 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12255 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12256 to local and remote transports.
12258 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12259 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12260 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12261 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12262 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12263 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12264 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12267 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12268 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12269 client is connected.
12272 .vitem &$host_address$&
12273 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12274 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12275 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12276 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12278 .vitem &$host_data$&
12279 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12280 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12281 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12282 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12284 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12285 message = $host_data
12287 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12288 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12289 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12290 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12291 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12292 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12293 variables is set to &"1"&.
12296 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12297 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12300 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12301 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12302 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12305 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12306 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12307 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12308 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12309 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12310 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12311 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12312 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12313 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12314 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12316 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12317 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12318 &%authresults%& expansion item.
12321 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12322 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12323 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12325 .vitem &$host_port$&
12326 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12327 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12328 for an outbound connection.
12330 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12331 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12332 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12333 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12334 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12335 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12338 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12339 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12340 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12341 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12342 a unique name for the file.
12344 .vitem &$interface_address$&
12345 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12346 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12348 .vitem &$interface_port$&
12349 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12350 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12354 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12355 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12356 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12360 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12361 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12362 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12365 .vitem &$load_average$&
12366 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12367 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12368 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12369 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12371 .vitem &$local_part$&
12372 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12373 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12374 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12375 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12376 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12378 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12379 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12380 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12381 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12384 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12385 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12386 .cindex affix variables
12387 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12388 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12389 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12390 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12392 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12393 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12394 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12397 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12398 local part of the recipient address.
12400 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12401 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12402 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12404 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12407 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12408 abc\:xyz@test.example
12410 the value of &$local_part$& is
12414 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12415 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12418 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12420 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12421 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12422 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12424 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12425 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12426 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12427 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12428 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12429 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12430 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12432 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12433 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12434 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12435 variable expands to nothing.
12437 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12438 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12439 .cindex affix variables
12440 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12441 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12442 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12444 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12445 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12446 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12447 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12448 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12450 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12451 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12452 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12453 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12455 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12456 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12457 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12459 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12460 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12461 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12462 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12463 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12464 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12465 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12466 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12468 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12469 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12470 This contains the expanded value of the
12471 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12474 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12475 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12476 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12477 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12478 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12479 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12481 .vitem &$log_space$&
12482 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12483 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12484 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12485 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12486 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12487 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12490 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12491 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12492 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12493 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12494 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12495 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12496 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12497 and &"yes"& if it was.
12498 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12499 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12500 as authenticated data.
12502 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12503 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12504 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12505 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12506 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12507 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12508 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12511 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12512 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12513 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12514 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12515 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12517 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12518 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12519 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12520 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12521 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12522 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12524 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12526 .vitem &$message_age$&
12527 .cindex "message" "age of"
12528 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12529 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12530 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12533 .vitem &$message_body$&
12534 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12535 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12536 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12537 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12538 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12539 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12540 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12541 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12542 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12544 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12545 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12546 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12547 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12548 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12550 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12551 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12552 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12553 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12554 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12555 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12558 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12559 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12560 .cindex "message body" "size"
12561 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12562 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12563 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12564 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12565 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12567 If the spool file is wireformat
12568 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12569 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12571 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12572 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12573 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12574 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12575 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12576 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12577 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12578 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12580 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12581 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12582 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12583 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12584 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12585 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12587 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12588 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12589 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12590 contents of header lines is done.
12592 .vitem &$message_id$&
12593 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12595 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12596 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12597 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12598 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12599 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12600 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12601 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12602 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12603 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12604 from the body is not counted.
12606 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12607 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12608 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12609 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12610 header and the body).
12612 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12614 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12616 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12618 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12619 message has not yet been received.
12621 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12623 .vitem &$message_size$&
12624 .cindex "size" "of message"
12625 .cindex "message" "size"
12626 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12627 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12628 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12629 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12630 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12631 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12632 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12633 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12634 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12636 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12637 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12638 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12639 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12641 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12642 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12643 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12644 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12646 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12647 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12648 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12650 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12651 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12652 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12653 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12654 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12655 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12656 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12657 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12658 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12659 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12661 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12662 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12663 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12665 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12666 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12667 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12668 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12669 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12670 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12671 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12672 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12673 the original address.
12675 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12676 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12677 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12678 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12679 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12681 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12682 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12683 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12685 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12686 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12687 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12688 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12689 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12690 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12691 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12692 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12693 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12695 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12696 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12697 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12698 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12699 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12700 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12701 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12702 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12705 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12706 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12707 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12708 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12710 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12711 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12712 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12713 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12716 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12718 This variable contains the current process id.
12720 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12721 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12722 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12723 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12724 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12725 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12726 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12727 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12728 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12729 variable"& error if encountered.
12731 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12732 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12733 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12734 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12735 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12736 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12737 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12740 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12741 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12742 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12743 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12745 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12747 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12749 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12750 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12751 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12752 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12754 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12755 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12756 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12757 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12759 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12760 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12761 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12762 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12764 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12765 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12766 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12767 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12769 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12770 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12771 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12773 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12774 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12775 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12776 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12778 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12779 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12780 .cindex "named queues"
12781 .cindex queues named
12782 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12787 .cindex router variables
12788 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
12789 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
12790 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
12791 and the eventual transport.
12794 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12795 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12796 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12797 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12798 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12800 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12801 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12802 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12803 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12804 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12805 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12807 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12808 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12809 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12810 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12811 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12813 .vitem &$received_count$&
12814 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12815 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12816 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12817 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12820 .vitem &$received_for$&
12821 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12822 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12823 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12824 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12825 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12827 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12828 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12829 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12830 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12831 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12832 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12833 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12836 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12837 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12838 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12839 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12840 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12842 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12844 .vitem &$received_port$&
12845 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12846 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12848 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12849 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12850 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12851 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12852 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12853 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12854 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12855 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12856 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12858 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12859 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12860 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12861 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12862 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12863 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12865 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12866 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12867 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12869 .vitem &$received_time$&
12870 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12871 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12872 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12874 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12875 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12876 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12877 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12878 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12880 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12881 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12883 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12884 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12885 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12886 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12888 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12889 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12890 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12891 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12894 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12895 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12898 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12901 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12902 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12906 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12909 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12912 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12913 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12915 .vitem &$recipients$&
12916 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12917 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12918 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12919 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12920 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12924 In a system filter file.
12926 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12927 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12928 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12929 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12931 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12935 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12936 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12937 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12938 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12939 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12940 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12943 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12944 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12945 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12946 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12948 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12949 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12950 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12951 these variables contain the
12952 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12955 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12956 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12957 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12958 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12959 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12960 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12961 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12963 .vitem &$return_path$&
12964 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12965 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12966 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12967 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12968 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12969 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12970 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12971 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12972 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12973 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12976 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12977 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12978 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12980 .vitem &$router_name$&
12981 .cindex "router" "name"
12982 .cindex "name" "of router"
12983 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12984 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12987 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12988 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12989 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12990 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12991 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12992 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12993 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12996 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12997 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12998 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12999 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13000 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13001 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13002 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13003 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13005 .vitem &$sender_address$&
13006 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
13007 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13008 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13009 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13010 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13012 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13013 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13014 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13015 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13016 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13017 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13018 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13019 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13021 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13022 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13023 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13025 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13026 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13027 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13029 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13030 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13031 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13032 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13033 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13036 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13037 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13039 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13040 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13041 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13042 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13044 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13045 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13046 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13047 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13048 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13049 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13050 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13051 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13052 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13053 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13054 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13055 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13056 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13058 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13059 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13060 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13061 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13062 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13064 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13065 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13066 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13067 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13068 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13069 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13071 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13072 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13073 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13074 this variable contains that
13075 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13077 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13078 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13079 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13080 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13081 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13082 &$authenticated_id$&.
13084 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13085 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13086 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13087 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13088 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13089 resolver library states that both
13090 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13091 other times, this variable is false.
13093 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13094 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13095 library, by setting:
13100 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13101 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13103 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13104 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13106 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13107 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13108 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13109 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13112 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13113 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13114 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13115 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13116 other means, this variable is empty.
13118 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13119 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13120 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13121 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13122 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13123 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13124 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13126 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13127 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13128 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13129 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13131 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13132 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13133 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13136 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13137 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13138 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13139 following are true:
13142 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13144 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13145 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13146 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13148 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13149 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13150 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13152 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13153 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13154 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13156 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13157 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13158 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13159 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13161 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13163 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13164 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13168 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13169 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13170 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13171 number that was used on the remote host.
13173 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13174 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13175 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13176 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13177 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13180 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13181 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13182 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13183 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13185 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13186 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13187 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13188 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13189 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13190 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13191 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13192 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13193 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13194 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13195 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13198 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13199 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13200 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13201 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13202 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13204 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13205 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13206 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13207 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13208 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13210 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13211 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13212 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13213 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13214 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13215 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13216 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13218 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13219 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13220 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13221 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13222 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13224 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13225 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13226 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13227 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13228 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13229 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13231 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
13232 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13233 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13234 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13235 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13240 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13241 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13242 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13243 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13245 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13246 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13247 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13248 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13249 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13250 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13251 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13253 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13254 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13255 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13256 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13257 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13260 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13261 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13262 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13263 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13264 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13265 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13266 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13267 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13268 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13269 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13270 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13272 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13273 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13274 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13275 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13276 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13277 message is junk mail.
13279 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13280 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13281 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13282 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13284 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13285 &$spf_received$& &&&
13287 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13288 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13289 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13290 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13292 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13293 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13294 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13296 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13297 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13298 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13299 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13300 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13301 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13303 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13304 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13305 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13306 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13307 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13308 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13309 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13310 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13312 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13314 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13317 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13318 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13319 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13320 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13321 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13322 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13324 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13325 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13326 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13327 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13328 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13329 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13330 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13331 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13333 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13334 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13337 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13338 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13339 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13340 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13341 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13342 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13344 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13345 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13346 .cindex certificate variables
13347 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13348 inbound connection when the message was received.
13349 It is only useful as the argument of a
13350 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13351 or a &%def%& condition.
13353 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13354 when a list of more than one
13355 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13357 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13358 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13359 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13360 inbound connection when the message was received.
13361 It is only useful as the argument of a
13362 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13363 or a &%def%& condition.
13364 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13365 which is not the leaf.
13367 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13368 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13369 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13370 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13371 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13372 or a &%def%& condition.
13374 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13375 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13376 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13377 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13378 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13379 or a &%def%& condition.
13380 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13381 which is not the leaf.
13383 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13384 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13385 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13386 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13388 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13389 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13392 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13393 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13394 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13395 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13396 and &"0"& otherwise.
13398 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13399 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13400 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13401 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13402 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13403 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13404 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13405 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13406 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13408 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13409 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13410 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13413 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13414 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13415 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13418 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13419 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13421 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13422 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13423 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13424 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13427 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13428 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13429 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13432 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13433 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13434 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13436 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13437 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13438 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13439 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13441 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13442 1 No response to request
13443 2 Response not verified
13444 3 Verification failed
13445 4 Verification succeeded
13448 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13449 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13450 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13451 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13452 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13454 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13455 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13456 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13457 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13458 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13459 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13460 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13461 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13462 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13463 which is not the leaf.
13465 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13466 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13469 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13470 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13471 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13472 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13473 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13474 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13475 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13476 which is not the leaf.
13478 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13479 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13480 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13481 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13482 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13483 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13484 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13485 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13486 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13487 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13488 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13490 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13491 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13494 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13495 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13496 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13498 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13501 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13502 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13503 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13505 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13506 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13507 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13508 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13510 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13511 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13512 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13514 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13515 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13516 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13518 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13519 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13520 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13521 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13522 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13523 values for those that are behind (west).
13526 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13527 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13528 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13530 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13531 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13532 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13533 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13536 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13537 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13538 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13541 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13542 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13543 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13544 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13546 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13547 .cindex "transport" "name"
13548 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13549 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13550 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13553 .vindex "&$value$&"
13554 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13555 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13556 &*reduce*& expansion.
13558 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13559 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13560 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13561 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13564 .vitem &$version_number$&
13565 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13566 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13567 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13569 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13570 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13571 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13572 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13574 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13575 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13576 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13577 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13583 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13584 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13586 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13587 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13588 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13589 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13590 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13591 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13596 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13599 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13600 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13601 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13602 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13603 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13604 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13605 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13606 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13607 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13609 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13610 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13611 should usually be something like
13613 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13615 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13616 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13617 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13618 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13619 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13620 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13621 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13622 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13626 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13627 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13628 a startup when Exim is entered.
13630 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13631 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13634 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13635 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13638 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13639 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13640 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13641 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13642 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13643 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13647 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13648 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13649 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13650 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13654 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13655 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13657 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13658 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13659 with an error message of the form
13661 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13663 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13664 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13665 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13666 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13667 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13668 that was passed to &%die%&.
13671 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13672 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13673 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13676 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13678 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13679 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13680 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13682 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13683 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13684 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13685 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13687 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13688 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13689 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13690 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13691 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13692 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13693 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13696 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13697 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13698 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13699 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13700 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13701 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13702 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13703 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13704 avoided, but the output is lost.
13706 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13707 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13708 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13709 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13710 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13711 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13712 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13714 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13716 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13717 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13718 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13719 as the first subroutine argument.
13723 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13724 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13726 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13727 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13728 "Starting the daemon"
13729 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13730 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13731 .cindex "network interface"
13732 .cindex "interface" "network"
13733 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13734 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13735 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13736 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13737 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13738 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13739 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13740 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13741 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13742 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13743 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13746 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13747 and ports to listen on.
13749 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13750 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13751 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13752 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13753 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13754 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13755 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13756 as an error situation.
13758 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13759 for the outgoing connection.
13763 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13764 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13765 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13766 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13767 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13769 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13770 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13771 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13772 chapter describes how they operate.
13774 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13775 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13779 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13780 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13781 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13785 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13787 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13789 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13790 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13793 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13794 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13795 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13796 colons. For example:
13798 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13801 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13803 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13804 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13807 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13808 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13810 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13811 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13814 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13815 with a colon separator, for example:
13817 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13818 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13822 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13823 default setting contains just one port:
13825 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13827 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13828 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13829 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13830 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13831 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13835 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13836 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13837 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13838 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13839 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13840 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13842 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13844 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13846 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13848 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13852 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13853 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13854 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13855 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13856 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13857 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13860 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13861 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13862 If there are any items that do not
13863 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13864 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13865 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13866 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13870 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13873 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13875 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13876 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13877 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13881 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13882 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13883 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13884 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13885 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13886 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13887 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13888 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13889 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13890 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13891 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13892 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13893 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13896 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13897 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13898 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13900 The common use of this option is expected to be
13902 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13905 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13906 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13908 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13909 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13910 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13911 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13912 connections via the daemon.)
13917 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13918 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13919 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13920 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13921 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13922 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13923 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13924 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13926 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13928 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13929 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13930 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13931 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13932 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13933 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13935 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13937 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13938 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13939 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13940 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13941 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13943 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13944 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13945 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13946 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13947 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13948 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13949 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13950 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13951 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13952 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13953 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13954 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13956 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13957 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13958 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13959 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13960 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13964 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13965 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13967 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13968 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13970 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13971 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13972 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13973 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13975 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13977 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13979 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13981 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13982 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13984 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13985 IPv4 loopback address only:
13987 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13989 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13991 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13993 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13997 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13998 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13999 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14000 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14003 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14004 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14005 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14006 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14008 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14009 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14010 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14011 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14012 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14013 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14014 used for listening. Consider this example:
14016 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14018 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14020 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14022 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14023 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14026 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14027 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14028 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14029 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14030 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14031 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14032 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14033 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14037 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14038 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14039 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14040 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14041 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14042 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14048 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14049 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14051 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14052 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14053 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14054 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14057 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14058 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14060 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14061 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14062 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14064 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14065 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14066 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14067 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14071 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14072 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14073 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14074 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14075 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14076 listed in more than one group.
14078 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14080 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14081 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14082 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14083 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14084 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14085 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14086 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14087 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14088 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14089 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14090 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14094 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14096 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14097 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14098 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14099 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14100 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14101 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14106 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14108 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14109 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14110 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14111 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14112 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14113 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14114 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14115 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14116 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14117 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14118 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14119 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14124 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14126 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14127 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14128 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14129 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14130 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14131 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14132 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14133 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14134 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14135 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14136 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14137 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14138 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14139 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14140 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14145 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14147 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14148 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14149 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14150 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14155 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14157 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14158 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14159 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14160 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14161 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14162 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14163 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14164 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14165 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14166 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14167 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14168 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14169 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14170 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14171 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14176 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14178 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14179 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14184 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14186 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14187 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14188 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14193 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14195 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14196 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14197 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14198 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14199 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14200 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14201 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14206 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14208 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14209 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14210 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14211 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14212 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14213 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14214 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14215 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14216 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14217 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14218 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14219 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14220 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14221 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14222 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14223 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14225 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14226 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14227 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14228 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14229 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14234 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14236 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14237 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14238 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14239 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14240 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14241 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14242 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14243 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14244 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14245 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14246 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14247 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14248 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14249 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14250 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14251 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14252 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14253 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14254 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14255 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14256 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14257 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14259 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14260 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14261 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14262 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14263 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14264 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14265 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14266 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14267 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14268 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14269 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14270 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14271 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14272 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14273 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14274 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14275 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14276 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14277 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14278 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14283 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14285 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14287 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14289 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14290 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14291 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14296 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14298 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14299 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14300 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14301 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14302 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14303 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14304 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14305 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14306 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14307 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14308 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14309 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14310 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14311 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14312 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14313 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14314 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14319 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14321 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14322 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14323 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14324 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14325 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14326 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14327 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14328 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14333 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14335 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14336 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14337 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14338 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14339 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14340 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14341 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14342 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14348 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14350 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14357 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14358 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14361 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14362 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14363 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14364 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14365 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14366 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14367 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14368 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14369 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14370 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14371 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14372 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14373 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14374 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14375 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14376 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14377 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14379 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14380 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14381 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14382 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14383 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14384 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14385 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14386 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14387 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14388 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14389 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14390 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14391 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14392 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14393 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14394 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14399 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14401 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14402 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14403 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14404 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14405 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14406 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14407 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14408 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14409 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14410 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14411 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14416 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14418 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14419 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14420 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14421 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14423 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14424 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14425 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14426 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14427 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14428 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14429 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14430 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14431 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14432 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14437 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14439 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14440 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14442 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14443 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14444 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14445 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14446 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14451 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14453 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14454 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14455 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14456 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14457 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14458 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14459 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14460 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14461 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14462 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14463 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14464 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14465 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14466 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14467 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14468 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14469 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14470 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14471 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14472 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14473 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14474 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14475 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14476 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14481 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14483 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14484 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14485 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14486 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14487 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14488 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14489 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14490 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14491 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14492 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14493 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14494 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14495 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14496 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14497 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14502 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14503 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14506 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14508 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14509 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14510 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14511 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14512 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14513 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14514 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14516 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14517 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14518 It now defaults to true.
14519 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14521 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14524 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14526 log_selector = +8bitmime
14529 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14530 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14531 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14532 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14533 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14536 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14537 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14538 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14541 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14542 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14543 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14544 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14545 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14547 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14548 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14549 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14550 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14551 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14553 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14554 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14555 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14556 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14558 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14559 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14560 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14561 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14562 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14564 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14565 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14566 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14567 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14568 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14569 This option defines the ACL that,
14570 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14571 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14572 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14573 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14575 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14576 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14577 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14578 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14579 of a received message.
14580 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14582 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14583 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14584 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14585 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14587 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14588 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14589 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14590 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14592 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14593 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14594 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14595 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14596 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14599 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14600 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14601 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14602 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14604 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14605 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14606 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14607 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14608 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14610 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14611 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14612 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14613 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14614 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14616 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14617 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14618 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14619 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14620 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14622 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14623 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14624 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14627 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14628 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14629 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14630 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14632 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14633 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14634 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14635 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14637 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14638 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14639 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14640 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14642 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14643 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14644 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14645 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14647 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14648 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14649 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14650 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14651 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14653 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14654 .cindex "admin user"
14655 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14656 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14657 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14658 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14659 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14660 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14661 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14663 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14664 .cindex "domain literal"
14665 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14666 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14667 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14668 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14670 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14671 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14672 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14673 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14674 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14675 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14676 the local host's IP addresses.
14679 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14680 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14681 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14682 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14683 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14684 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14685 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14686 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14687 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14689 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14690 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14691 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14692 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14693 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14694 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
14695 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
14697 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14698 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14699 letters, digits, and hyphens.
14702 If Exim is built with internationalization support
14703 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
14704 this option can be left as default.
14707 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
14708 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14709 suitable setting is:
14711 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14712 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14714 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14716 dns_check_names_pattern =
14718 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14721 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14722 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14723 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14724 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14725 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14726 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14727 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14728 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14729 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14730 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14731 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14733 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14734 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14735 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14736 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14737 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14738 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14740 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14741 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14742 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14743 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14745 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14747 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14748 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14749 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14750 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14753 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14754 .cindex "thawing messages"
14755 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14756 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14757 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14758 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14759 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14760 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14762 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14763 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14764 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14767 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14768 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14769 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14771 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14773 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14774 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14777 .option bi_command main string unset
14779 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14780 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14781 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14782 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14785 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14786 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14787 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14788 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14789 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14790 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14793 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14794 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14795 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14796 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14798 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14799 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14800 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14801 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14802 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14803 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14804 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14805 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14806 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14807 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14809 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14810 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14811 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14812 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14813 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14814 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14815 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14816 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14817 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14818 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14820 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14821 during reception of a message.
14822 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14824 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14827 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14828 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14829 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14830 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14833 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14834 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14835 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14836 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14837 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14838 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14839 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14840 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14841 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14843 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14844 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14845 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14846 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14847 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14850 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14851 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14852 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14853 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14854 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14855 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14856 connection. A typical setting might be:
14858 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14860 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14862 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14864 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14867 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14868 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14869 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14870 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14871 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14872 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14875 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14876 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14877 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14878 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14881 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14882 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14883 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14884 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14887 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14888 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14889 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14890 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14893 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14894 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14895 callout verification. The default value is
14897 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14899 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14902 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14903 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14906 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14907 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14909 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14910 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14911 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14912 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14913 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14914 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14915 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14916 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14917 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14918 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14921 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14922 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14925 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14926 .cindex "checking disk space"
14927 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14928 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14929 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14930 message is accepted.
14932 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14933 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14934 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14935 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14936 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14937 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14938 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14939 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14942 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14943 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14945 check_spool_space = 100M
14946 check_spool_inodes = 100
14948 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14949 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14952 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14953 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14954 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14956 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14957 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14958 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14959 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14960 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14961 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14963 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14964 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14965 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14967 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14968 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14969 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14971 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14972 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14973 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14974 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14976 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14977 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14978 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14979 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14981 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14983 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14984 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14985 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14986 administrative user.
14987 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14989 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14990 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14991 .cindex memory debugging
14992 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14993 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14994 it should normally be left as default.
14996 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14997 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14998 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14999 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15000 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15001 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15003 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
15004 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15005 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
15006 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15007 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15008 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15009 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15011 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15012 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
15014 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15015 .cindex "warning of delay"
15016 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15017 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15018 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15019 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15020 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15021 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15022 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15023 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15026 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15028 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15029 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15030 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15031 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15035 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15036 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15038 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15040 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15041 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15042 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15044 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15045 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15046 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15047 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15048 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15049 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15050 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15051 not sent. The default is:
15053 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15054 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15055 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15056 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15059 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15060 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15061 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15062 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15064 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15065 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15066 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15067 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15068 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15069 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15070 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15071 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15073 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15074 .cindex "load average"
15075 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15076 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15077 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15078 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15079 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15082 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15083 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15084 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15085 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15086 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15087 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15088 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15089 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15091 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15092 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15093 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15094 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15095 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15096 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15097 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15098 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15100 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15101 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15102 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15103 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15106 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15107 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15108 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15109 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15110 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15111 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15112 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15116 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512 : sha1"
15117 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15118 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15119 and an order of processing.
15120 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15122 Note that the presence of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15123 Signatures using the rsa-sha1 are however (as of writing) still common.
15124 The default inclusion of sha1 may be dropped in a future release.
15126 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15127 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15128 and an order of processing.
15129 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15131 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15132 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15136 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15137 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15138 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15139 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15140 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15141 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15144 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15145 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15146 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15147 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15148 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15149 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15150 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15151 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15152 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15153 by a setting such as this:
15155 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15157 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15158 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15159 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15160 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15161 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15162 options are applied after this global option.
15164 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15165 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15166 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15167 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15168 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15169 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15170 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15171 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15172 value of this option. The default pattern is
15174 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15175 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15177 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15178 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15179 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15180 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15181 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15184 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15185 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15186 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15188 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15189 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15190 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15191 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15193 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15194 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15195 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15196 not do it internally.
15197 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15198 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15200 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15201 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15202 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15205 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15206 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15207 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15208 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15209 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15210 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15212 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15215 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15216 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15217 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15218 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15219 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15220 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15221 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15222 domain matches this list.
15224 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15225 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15226 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15228 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15229 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15230 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15234 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15235 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15236 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15237 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15238 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15239 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15240 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15241 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15242 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15243 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15244 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15245 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15247 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15250 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15251 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15254 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15255 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15256 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15257 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15258 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15259 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15260 match with this expanded domain list.
15262 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15263 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15264 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15265 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15266 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15267 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15269 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15270 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15271 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15273 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15274 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15275 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15276 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15277 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15279 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15280 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15281 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15282 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15283 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15284 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15285 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15286 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15289 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15291 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15292 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15293 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15296 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15297 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15298 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15299 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15301 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15302 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15303 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15304 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15305 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15306 and accepted from, these hosts.
15307 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15308 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15309 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15310 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15313 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15314 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15315 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15316 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15317 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15318 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15320 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15322 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15323 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15325 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15326 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15327 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15328 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15329 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15330 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15331 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15332 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15333 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15336 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15337 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15338 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15339 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15340 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15341 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15342 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15343 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15344 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15346 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15347 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15348 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15349 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15350 are examined. For example:
15352 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15353 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15354 postmaster@mydomain.example
15356 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15357 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15358 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15359 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15360 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15361 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15362 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15365 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15366 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15367 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15369 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15371 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15372 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15373 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15374 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15375 overrides the default.
15377 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15378 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15379 and warning messages. For example:
15381 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15383 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15384 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15385 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15386 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15390 .option event_action main string&!! unset
15392 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15393 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15396 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15397 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15398 .cindex "Exim group"
15399 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15400 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15401 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15402 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15403 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15407 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15408 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15409 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15410 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15411 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15412 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15414 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15415 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15416 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15417 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15420 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15421 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15422 .cindex "Exim user"
15423 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15424 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15425 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15426 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15428 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15429 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15430 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15431 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15434 .option exim_version main string "current version"
15435 .cindex "Exim version"
15436 .cindex customizing "version number"
15437 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
15438 This option allows to override the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& Exim reports in
15439 various places. Use with care, this may fool stupid security scanners.
15442 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15443 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15444 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15445 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15448 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15449 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15451 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15452 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15454 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15455 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15456 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15457 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15458 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15459 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15460 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15461 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15462 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15463 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15467 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15468 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15469 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15470 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15471 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15472 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15473 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15474 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15477 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15478 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15479 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15480 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15484 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15485 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15486 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15487 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15488 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15489 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15490 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15491 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15492 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15493 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15494 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15495 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15496 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15497 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15498 logging that you require.
15501 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15503 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15504 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15505 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15506 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15507 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15508 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15509 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15510 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15512 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15513 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15514 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15517 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15518 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15519 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15520 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15522 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15526 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15527 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15530 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15531 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15532 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15533 implementations of TLS.
15536 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15537 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15538 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15541 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15546 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15547 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15548 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15549 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15550 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15551 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15555 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15556 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15557 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15558 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15559 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15560 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15561 sections are rejected.
15564 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15565 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15566 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15567 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15568 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15569 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15570 zero means &"no limit"&.
15575 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15576 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15577 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15578 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15579 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15580 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15581 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15582 if you want to do semantic checking.
15583 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15587 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15588 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15589 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15590 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15591 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15592 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15593 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15595 helo_allow_chars = _
15597 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15600 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15601 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15602 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15603 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15604 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15605 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15606 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15610 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15611 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15612 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15613 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15614 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15615 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15616 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15617 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15618 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15619 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15620 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15621 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15623 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15624 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15625 EHLO command either:
15628 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15630 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15631 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15632 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15633 calling host address, or
15635 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15638 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15639 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15640 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15642 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15643 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15644 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15646 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15647 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15648 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15649 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15650 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15651 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15652 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15653 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15654 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15657 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15658 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15659 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15660 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15661 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15662 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15663 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15664 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15665 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15667 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15668 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15669 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15670 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15671 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15673 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15674 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15675 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15676 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15679 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15680 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15681 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15682 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15683 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15684 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15685 default configuration file contains
15689 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15690 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15692 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15693 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15694 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15696 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15697 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15698 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15699 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15700 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15701 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15704 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15705 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15706 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15707 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15708 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15711 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15712 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15713 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15714 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15718 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15719 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15720 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15721 as soon as the connection is made.
15722 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15723 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15724 connections immediately.
15726 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15727 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15728 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15729 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15730 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15733 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15734 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15735 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15736 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15737 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15738 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15739 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15740 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15741 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15743 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15745 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15749 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15750 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15751 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15752 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15755 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15756 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15757 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15758 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15759 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15761 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15762 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15764 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15765 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15766 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15767 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15768 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15769 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15770 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15773 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15774 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15775 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15776 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15777 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15781 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15782 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15783 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15784 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15785 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15786 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15788 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15789 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15790 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15791 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15792 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15793 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15794 for frozen messages. For example,
15796 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15798 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15799 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15800 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15801 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15802 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15803 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15806 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15807 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15808 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15809 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15810 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15811 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15812 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15813 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15814 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15815 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15818 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15819 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15821 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15822 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15823 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15824 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15825 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15826 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15827 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15828 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15829 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15831 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15832 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15834 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15835 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15836 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15837 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15839 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15840 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15841 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15844 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15845 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15846 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15850 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15851 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15852 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15853 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15857 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15858 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15859 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15860 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15861 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15862 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15863 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15864 and constrained to be a directory.
15867 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15868 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15869 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15870 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15871 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15872 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15873 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15874 and constrained to be a file.
15877 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15878 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15879 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15880 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15881 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15882 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15885 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15886 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15887 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15888 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15889 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15890 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15891 identity to be proven.
15894 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15895 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15896 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15897 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15898 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15901 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15902 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15903 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15904 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15905 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15909 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15910 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15911 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15912 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15913 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15914 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15918 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15919 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15920 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15921 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15922 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15924 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15925 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15926 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15929 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15930 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15931 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15932 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15933 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15934 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15935 has been built with LDAP support.
15939 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15940 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15941 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15942 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15943 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15944 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15945 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15947 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15948 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15949 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15951 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15952 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15953 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15954 and the default qualify domain.
15956 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15957 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15958 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15959 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15961 .cindex "envelope from"
15962 .cindex "envelope sender"
15963 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15964 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15965 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15967 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15968 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15969 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15974 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15975 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15976 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15977 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15978 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15979 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15980 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15983 local_from_prefix = *-
15985 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15987 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15989 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15990 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15994 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15995 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15998 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15999 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16000 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16001 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16002 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16003 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16004 &%local_interfaces%& is
16006 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16008 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16010 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16013 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16014 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16015 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16016 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16017 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16018 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16019 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16020 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16024 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16025 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16026 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16027 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16028 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16029 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16030 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16031 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16036 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16037 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16038 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16039 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16040 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16041 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16042 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16043 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16044 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16045 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16046 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16047 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16048 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16049 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16050 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16054 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16055 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16056 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16057 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16058 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16059 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16060 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16061 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16063 A path must start with a slash.
16064 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16066 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16067 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16068 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16069 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16070 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16071 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16072 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16075 .option log_selector main string unset
16076 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16077 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16078 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16079 minus characters. For example:
16081 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16083 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16084 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16087 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16088 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16089 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16090 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16091 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16092 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16093 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16094 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16095 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16096 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16097 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16098 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16099 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16102 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16103 .cindex "too many open files"
16104 .cindex "open files, too many"
16105 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16106 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16107 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16108 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16109 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16110 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16111 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16112 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16113 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16114 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16115 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16116 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16119 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16120 .cindex "length of login name"
16121 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16122 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16123 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16124 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16125 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16126 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16129 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16130 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16131 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16132 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16133 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16134 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16135 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16136 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16139 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16140 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16141 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16142 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16143 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16144 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16145 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16148 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16149 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16150 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16151 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16152 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16153 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16154 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16155 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16156 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16157 empty string, the option is ignored.
16160 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16161 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16162 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16163 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16164 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16165 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16166 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16167 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16168 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16169 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16170 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16171 colons will become hyphens.
16174 .option message_logs main boolean true
16175 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16176 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16177 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16178 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16179 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16180 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16181 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16182 which is not affected by this option.
16185 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16186 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16187 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16188 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16189 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16190 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16191 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16192 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16193 optionally followed by K or M.
16195 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16196 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16197 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16198 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16199 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16201 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16202 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16203 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16204 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16205 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16206 message that an individual transport can process.
16208 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16209 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16210 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16211 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16212 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16213 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16214 some problems may result.
16216 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16217 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16218 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16221 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16222 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16223 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16225 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16227 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16228 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16229 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16230 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16231 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16234 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16235 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16236 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16237 contains a full description of this facility.
16241 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16242 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16243 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16244 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16245 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16248 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16249 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16250 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16251 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16252 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16255 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16256 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16257 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16258 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16259 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16261 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16262 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16265 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16267 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16268 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16272 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
16273 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16274 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16275 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16276 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16278 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16279 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16280 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16281 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16282 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16283 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16284 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16286 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16287 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16288 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16289 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16290 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16292 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16294 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16295 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16296 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16297 some now infamous attacks.
16301 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16302 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16303 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16305 # Disable older protocol versions:
16306 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16309 Possible options may include:
16313 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16315 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16317 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16321 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16323 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16325 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16327 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16329 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16331 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16335 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16349 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16353 &`single_ecdh_use`&
16355 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16357 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16359 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16363 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
16366 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16367 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16368 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16369 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16370 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16371 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16374 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16375 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16376 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16377 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16378 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16381 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16382 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16383 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16384 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
16385 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16386 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16387 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16388 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16389 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16390 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16393 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16394 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16395 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16396 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16397 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16398 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16399 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16402 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
16404 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16405 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16408 .option perl_startup main string unset
16410 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16411 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16413 .option perl_startup main boolean false
16415 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16418 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16419 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16420 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16421 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16422 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16423 PostgreSQL support.
16426 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16427 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16428 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16429 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16430 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16433 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16435 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16437 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16438 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16439 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16442 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16443 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16444 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16445 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16446 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16447 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16448 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16449 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16450 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16453 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16454 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16455 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16456 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16457 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16458 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16459 commands are acceptable.
16460 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16462 Currently the option name &"X_PIPE_CONNECT"& is used.
16466 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16467 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16468 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16469 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16470 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16471 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16472 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16473 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16475 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16476 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16477 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16478 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16479 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16480 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16481 volume of mail. Use with care!
16484 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16485 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16486 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16487 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16488 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16489 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16490 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16491 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16492 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16493 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16495 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16496 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16497 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16498 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16499 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16500 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16503 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16504 .cindex "printing characters"
16505 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16506 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16507 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16508 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16509 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16510 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16513 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16514 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16515 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16516 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16517 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16521 .option process_log_path main string unset
16522 .cindex "process log path"
16523 .cindex "log" "process log"
16524 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16525 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16526 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16527 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16528 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16529 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16530 different spool directories.
16533 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16534 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16538 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16539 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16540 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16543 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16544 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16545 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16546 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16547 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16548 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16549 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16550 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16551 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16553 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16554 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16555 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16556 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16557 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16558 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16559 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16562 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16563 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16564 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16568 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16569 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16570 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16571 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16572 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16573 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16574 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16575 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16578 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16579 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16581 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16582 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16583 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16584 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16587 .option queue_only main boolean false
16588 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16589 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16590 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16591 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16592 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16593 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16595 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16596 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16597 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16598 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16601 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16602 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16603 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16604 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16605 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16606 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16607 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16608 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16609 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16611 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16613 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16614 &_/some/file_& exists.
16617 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16618 .cindex "load average"
16619 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16620 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16621 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16622 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16623 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16624 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16625 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16628 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16629 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16630 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16631 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16634 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16635 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16636 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16637 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16638 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16639 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16640 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16641 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16642 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16643 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16644 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16645 re-evaluated for each message.
16648 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16649 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16650 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16651 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16652 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16653 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16656 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16657 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16658 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16659 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16660 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16661 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16662 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16663 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16664 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16665 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16666 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16667 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16668 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16672 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16673 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16674 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16675 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16676 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16677 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16678 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16679 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16680 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16682 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16683 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16684 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16685 the daemon's command line.
16687 .cindex queues named
16688 .cindex "named queues"
16689 To set limits for different named queues use
16690 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16692 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16693 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16694 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16695 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16696 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16697 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16698 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16699 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16700 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16701 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16702 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16703 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16704 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16708 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16709 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16710 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16711 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16712 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16713 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16714 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16716 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16717 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16718 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16719 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16720 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16721 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16722 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16723 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16724 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16727 The default setting is:
16730 received_header_text = Received: \
16731 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16732 {${if def:sender_ident \
16733 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16734 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16735 by $primary_hostname \
16736 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16737 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16738 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16739 ${if def:sender_address \
16740 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16741 id $message_exim_id\
16742 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16746 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16747 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16748 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16749 header lines such as the following:
16751 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16752 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16753 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16754 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16755 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16756 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16757 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16759 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16760 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16761 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16762 message was accepted.
16765 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16766 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16767 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16768 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16769 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16770 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16771 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16772 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16775 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16776 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16777 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16778 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16779 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16780 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16781 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16782 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16783 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16784 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16785 option was not set.
16788 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16789 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16790 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16791 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16792 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16793 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16794 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16795 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16798 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16799 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16800 RCPT commands in a single message.
16803 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16804 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16805 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16806 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16807 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16808 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16809 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16812 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16813 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16814 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16815 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16816 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16817 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16818 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16819 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16820 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16821 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16822 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16823 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16824 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16825 tagged with its process id.
16827 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16828 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16829 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16830 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16833 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16834 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16835 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16836 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16837 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16838 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16839 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16840 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16841 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16842 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16843 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16845 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16846 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16847 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16848 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16851 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16852 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16853 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16854 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16855 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16857 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16859 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16860 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16863 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16864 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16865 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16866 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16867 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16871 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16872 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16873 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16874 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16875 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16876 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16877 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16881 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16882 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16883 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16884 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16885 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16886 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16887 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16888 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16889 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16890 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16893 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16894 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16897 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16899 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16900 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16901 an item in the list.
16902 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16905 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16906 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16907 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16908 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16909 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16912 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16913 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16914 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16915 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16916 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16917 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16918 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16919 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16920 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16921 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16923 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
16924 .cindex "environment"
16925 This option allows to add individual environment variables that the
16926 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16927 default list is empty.
16930 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16931 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16932 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16933 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16934 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16935 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16936 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16940 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16941 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16942 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16943 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16944 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16945 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16946 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16947 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16948 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16949 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16950 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16954 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16955 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16956 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16958 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16959 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16960 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16961 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16962 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16963 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16965 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16966 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16967 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16968 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16971 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16972 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16973 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16974 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16975 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16976 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16977 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16978 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16980 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16981 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16982 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16983 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16984 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16985 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16986 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16987 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16990 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16991 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16992 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16993 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16997 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16998 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16999 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17000 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17001 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17002 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17003 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17004 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17005 . the option name to split.
17007 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
17008 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17009 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17010 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17011 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17012 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17013 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17014 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17015 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17019 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17020 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17021 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17022 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17023 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17024 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17025 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17026 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17027 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17028 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17029 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17031 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17032 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17033 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17034 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17035 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17036 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17040 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17041 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17042 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17043 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17044 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17045 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17046 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17047 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17048 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17049 to all messages received in the same connection.
17051 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17052 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17053 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17054 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17057 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17059 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17060 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17061 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17062 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17063 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17064 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17065 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17066 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17067 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17068 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17069 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17070 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17071 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17074 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17075 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17076 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17077 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17078 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17079 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17080 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17081 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17082 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17083 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17084 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17087 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17088 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17089 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17090 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17093 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17094 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17095 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17096 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17097 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17098 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17099 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17100 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17101 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17103 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17104 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17105 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17106 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17108 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17109 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17110 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17111 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17112 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17115 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17116 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17119 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17120 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17121 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17122 &%helo_data%& value.
17124 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17125 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17126 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17127 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17128 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17129 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17130 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17132 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17133 $version_number $tod_full
17135 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17136 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17137 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17138 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17139 multiline response).
17142 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17143 .cindex "checking disk space"
17144 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17145 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17146 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17147 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17148 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17149 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17150 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17153 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17154 .cindex "connection backlog"
17155 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17156 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17157 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17158 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17159 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17160 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17161 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17162 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17163 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17164 attacks by SYN flooding.
17167 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17168 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17169 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17170 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17171 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17172 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17173 fewer, but they still exist.
17175 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17176 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17177 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17178 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17179 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17180 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17181 does detect many instances.
17183 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17184 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17185 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17186 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17190 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17191 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17192 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17193 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17194 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17195 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17196 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17197 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17200 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17201 $sender_host_address
17203 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17204 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17205 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17206 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17207 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17211 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17212 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17213 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17214 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17215 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17218 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17219 .cindex "load average"
17220 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17221 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17222 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17223 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17224 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17225 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17229 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17230 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17231 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17232 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17233 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17235 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17237 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17238 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17239 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17240 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17241 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17243 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17244 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17245 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17246 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17247 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17248 not count towards the limit.
17252 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17253 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17254 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17255 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17256 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17259 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17260 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17264 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17265 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17266 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17267 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17268 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17269 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17272 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17273 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17274 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17275 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17277 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17278 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17279 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17280 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17284 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17286 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17287 fractional parts are allowed here.
17289 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17291 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17292 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17295 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17296 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17298 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17299 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17301 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17302 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17303 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17304 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17307 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17308 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17311 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17312 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17315 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17316 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17317 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17318 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17319 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17320 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17321 the message is abandoned.
17322 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17324 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17325 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17327 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17328 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17330 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17331 expanded before use and may depend on
17332 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17336 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17337 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17338 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17339 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17340 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17343 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17344 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17345 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17348 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17349 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17350 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17351 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17352 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17353 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17354 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17355 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17356 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17357 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17359 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17360 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17364 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17365 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17366 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17367 the availability thereof is advertised in
17368 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17369 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17372 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17373 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17374 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17375 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17379 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17380 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17381 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17385 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17386 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
17387 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
17388 .cindex "directories, multiple"
17389 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17390 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17391 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17392 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17393 arrival of the message.
17395 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17396 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17397 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17398 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17399 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17401 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17402 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17403 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17404 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17405 automatically deleted.
17407 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17408 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17409 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17410 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17411 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17412 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17413 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17414 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17415 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17418 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17419 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17420 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17421 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17422 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17423 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17424 &$primary_hostname$&.
17426 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17427 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17428 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17429 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17430 as failures in the configuration file.
17432 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17433 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17435 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17436 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17437 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17438 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17439 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17440 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17443 The following variables will not have useful values:
17445 $max_received_linelength
17450 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17451 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17452 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17453 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17455 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17456 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17457 The transmission benefit is maintained.
17459 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17460 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17461 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17462 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17464 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17465 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17466 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17467 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17468 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17469 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17471 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17472 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17473 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17474 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17475 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17476 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17477 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17480 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17481 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17482 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17483 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17484 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17485 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17486 domain causes a syntax error.
17487 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17491 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17492 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17493 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17494 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17495 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17496 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17497 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17498 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17499 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17500 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17501 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17502 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17505 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17506 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17507 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17508 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17509 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17510 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17511 details of Exim's logging.
17514 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17515 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17516 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17517 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17518 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17519 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17520 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17524 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17525 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17526 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17527 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17528 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17532 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17533 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17534 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17535 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17536 details of Exim's logging.
17539 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17540 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17541 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17542 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17543 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17544 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17545 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17546 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17547 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17548 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17549 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17550 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17553 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17554 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17555 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17556 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17557 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17558 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17561 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17562 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17563 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17564 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17565 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17567 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17568 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17569 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17570 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17571 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17573 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17574 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17575 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17576 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17577 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17578 contains the pipe command.
17581 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17582 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17583 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17584 is used in a system filter.
17587 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17588 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17589 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17590 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17591 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17592 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17593 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17594 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17595 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17596 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17598 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17599 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17600 transport option overrides.
17603 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17604 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17605 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17606 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17607 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17608 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17609 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17610 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17611 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17612 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17613 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17614 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17618 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17619 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17620 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17621 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17622 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17623 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17624 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17625 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17626 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17627 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17629 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17630 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17631 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17634 .option timezone main string unset
17635 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17636 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17637 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17638 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17639 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17640 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17644 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17645 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17646 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17647 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17648 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17649 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17652 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17653 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17654 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17655 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17656 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17657 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17658 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17659 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17660 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17661 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17662 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17665 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17666 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17667 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17668 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17669 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
17670 Commonly only one file is needed.
17671 The server's private key is also
17672 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17673 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17675 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17676 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17677 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17678 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17680 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17681 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17683 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17684 when a list of more than one
17685 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17687 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17688 when a list of more than one file is used.
17690 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17691 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17692 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17693 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17695 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17696 generated for every connection.
17698 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17699 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17700 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17701 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17702 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17704 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17706 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17707 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17708 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17710 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17713 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17714 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17715 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17716 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17717 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17718 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17720 The value must be at least 1024.
17722 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17723 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17724 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17726 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17729 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17730 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17731 larger prime than requested.
17734 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17735 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17736 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17737 to be used by Exim.
17739 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17740 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17741 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17742 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17744 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17745 then it names a file from which DH
17746 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17747 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17748 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17749 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17750 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17751 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17753 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17756 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17757 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17758 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17759 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17761 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17762 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17764 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17765 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17766 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17768 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17769 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17770 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17771 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17772 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17774 The available standard primes are:
17775 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17776 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17777 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17778 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17780 The available additional primes are:
17781 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17783 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17784 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17785 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17786 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17787 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17789 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17790 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17791 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17793 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17794 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17795 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17796 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17797 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17800 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17801 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17802 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17803 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17804 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17805 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17806 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17809 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17810 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17811 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17812 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17814 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17815 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17816 for valid selections.
17818 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17819 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17820 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17822 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17825 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17826 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17827 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17829 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17830 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17831 Certificate Authority.
17833 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17838 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17839 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17840 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17843 The file(s) should be in DER format,
17844 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later when an optional filetype prefix
17845 can be used. The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
17846 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
17847 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
17848 When a PEM format file is used it may contain multiple proofs,
17849 for multiple certificate chain element proofs under TLS1.3.
17852 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17855 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17856 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17857 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17858 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17862 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17863 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17864 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17865 files which contains the server's private keys.
17866 If this option is unset, or if
17867 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17868 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17869 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17871 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17874 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17875 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17876 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17877 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17878 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17879 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17883 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17884 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17885 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17886 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17887 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17888 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17889 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17890 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17891 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17892 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17893 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17896 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17897 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17898 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17899 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17902 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17903 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17904 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17905 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17907 or the absolute path to
17908 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17909 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17911 The "system" value for the option will use a
17912 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17913 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17914 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17917 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17918 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17920 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17922 either by file or directory
17923 are added to those given by the system default location.
17925 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17926 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17927 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17928 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17929 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17930 use the explicit directory version.
17932 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17934 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17938 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17939 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17940 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17941 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17942 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17943 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17944 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17945 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17947 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17948 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17949 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17950 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17951 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17952 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17953 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17955 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17956 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17957 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17958 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17959 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17960 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17961 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17964 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17968 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17969 .cindex "trusted groups"
17970 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17971 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17972 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17973 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17974 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17975 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17976 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17979 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17980 .cindex "trusted users"
17981 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17982 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17983 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17984 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17985 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17986 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17987 Exim user are trusted.
17989 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17990 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17991 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17992 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17993 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17994 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17995 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17996 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17997 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18000 .option unknown_username main string unset
18001 See &%unknown_login%&.
18003 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18004 .cindex "trusted users"
18005 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18006 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18007 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18008 .cindex "envelope from"
18009 .cindex "envelope sender"
18010 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18011 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18012 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18013 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18014 is used) is ignored.
18016 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18017 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18019 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18021 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18022 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18023 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18024 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18025 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18026 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18027 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18028 followed by a hyphen
18029 by a setting like this:
18031 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18033 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18034 restriction, you can use
18036 untrusted_set_sender = *
18038 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18039 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18040 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18041 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18042 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18043 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18044 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18045 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18047 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18048 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18049 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18050 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18054 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18055 .cindex "&""From""& line"
18056 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18057 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18058 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18059 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18060 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18061 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18062 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18063 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18065 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18066 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18068 The pattern can be seen by running
18070 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18072 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18073 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18074 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18075 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18076 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18077 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18080 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18081 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18084 .option warn_message_file main string unset
18085 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18086 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18087 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18088 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18089 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18090 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18091 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18094 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18095 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18096 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18097 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18098 .ecindex IIDconfima
18099 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
18104 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18105 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18107 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18108 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18109 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18110 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18111 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
18113 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18114 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18115 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18116 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18117 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18121 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18122 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18123 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18124 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18125 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18126 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18127 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18129 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18130 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18131 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18132 routers, and the eventual transport.
18134 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18135 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18136 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18137 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18138 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18140 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18141 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18142 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18143 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18144 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18146 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18147 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18148 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18150 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18152 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18154 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18156 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18157 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18160 See also the &%set%& option below.
18163 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18164 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18165 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18166 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18167 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18168 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18169 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18173 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18175 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18176 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18177 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18178 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18179 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18184 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18185 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18186 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18187 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18188 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18189 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18190 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18191 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18192 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18193 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18196 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18198 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18201 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18203 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18204 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18205 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18206 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18209 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18210 .cindex "case of local parts"
18211 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18212 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18213 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18214 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18215 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18216 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18217 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18220 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18221 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18222 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18223 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18224 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18225 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18226 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18227 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18228 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18230 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18231 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18232 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18233 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18237 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18238 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
18239 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18240 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18242 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18243 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18244 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18245 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18246 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18247 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18248 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18249 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18250 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18251 the router is skipped.
18253 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18254 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18255 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18256 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18257 setting to achieve this. For example:
18259 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18261 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18262 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18263 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18267 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18268 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18269 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18270 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18271 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18272 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18273 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18274 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18276 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18277 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18279 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18280 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18282 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18283 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18284 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18286 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18288 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18290 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18293 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18295 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18296 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18300 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18301 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18302 be specified using &%condition%&.
18304 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18305 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18306 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18307 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18308 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18309 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18310 Router rules processing behavior.
18312 This is best illustrated in an example:
18314 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18315 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18317 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18320 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18323 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18324 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18325 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18326 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18327 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18328 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18329 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18330 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18332 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18333 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18334 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18335 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18338 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18339 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18340 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18341 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18342 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18345 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18346 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18347 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18348 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18349 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18350 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18351 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18352 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18353 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18354 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18355 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18356 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18357 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18358 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18362 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
18363 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18364 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18365 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18366 transport option of the same name.
18368 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18369 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18370 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18371 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18372 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18373 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18374 the dnssec request bit set.
18375 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18377 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18378 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18379 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18380 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18381 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18382 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18383 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18384 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18385 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18388 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18389 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18390 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18391 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18392 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18393 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18394 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18395 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18399 .option driver routers string unset
18400 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18404 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18405 .cindex "DSN" "success"
18406 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18407 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18408 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18409 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18410 Not effective on redirect routers.
18414 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18415 .cindex "envelope from"
18416 .cindex "envelope sender"
18417 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18418 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18419 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18420 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18421 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18422 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18423 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18425 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18426 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18427 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18430 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18431 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18432 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18433 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18435 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18436 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18437 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18438 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18444 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18445 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18446 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18447 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18448 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18450 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18451 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18452 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18453 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18454 setting &%return_path%&.
18456 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18457 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18458 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18462 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
18463 .cindex "address" "testing"
18464 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
18465 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18466 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18467 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18468 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18469 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18470 on for the system alias file.
18471 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18474 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18475 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18476 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18480 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
18481 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18482 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18483 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18487 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18488 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18489 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18493 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18494 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18495 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18499 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18500 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18501 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18502 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18503 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18504 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18505 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18506 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18507 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18509 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18510 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18511 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18512 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18513 transport for further details.
18516 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18517 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18518 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18519 .cindex "transport" "local"
18520 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18521 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18522 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18524 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18525 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18526 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18527 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18528 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18532 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18533 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18534 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18535 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18536 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18537 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18538 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18539 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18540 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18541 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18542 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18543 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18544 &"see"& the added header lines.
18546 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18547 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18548 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18549 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18551 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18552 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18554 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18555 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18557 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18558 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18559 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18560 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18561 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18562 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18563 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18564 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18565 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18566 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18570 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18571 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18572 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18573 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18574 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18575 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18576 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18577 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18578 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18579 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18580 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18581 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18582 &"see"& the original header lines.
18584 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18585 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18586 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18589 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18590 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18592 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18593 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18595 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18596 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18597 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18598 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18600 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18601 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18602 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18606 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18607 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18608 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18609 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18610 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18611 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18612 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18615 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18619 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18621 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18622 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18623 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18624 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18625 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18626 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18628 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18629 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18631 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18632 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18634 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18635 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18637 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18638 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18639 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18640 domain that is being routed.
18642 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18643 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18646 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18647 .cindex "additional groups"
18648 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18649 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18650 .cindex "transport" "local"
18651 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18652 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18653 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18654 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18655 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18659 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18660 .cindex affix "router precondition"
18661 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18662 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18663 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18664 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18665 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18668 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18669 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18670 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18671 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18672 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18673 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18674 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18675 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18676 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18678 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18679 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18680 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18681 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18682 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18683 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18684 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18685 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18686 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18687 the relevant transport.
18689 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18690 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18691 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18694 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18695 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18696 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18697 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18698 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18702 local_part_prefix = real-
18704 transport = local_delivery
18706 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18707 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18709 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18710 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18713 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18714 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18715 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18716 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18719 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18720 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18724 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18725 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18726 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18727 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18728 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18729 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18730 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18731 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18732 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18736 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18737 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18741 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18742 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18743 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18744 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18745 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18747 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18748 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18751 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18753 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18754 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18755 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18756 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18757 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18758 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18759 each virtual domain:
18763 local_parts = postmaster
18764 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18768 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18769 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18770 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18771 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18772 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18773 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18774 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18775 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18776 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18777 redirect addresses.
18781 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18782 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18783 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18784 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18785 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18786 delivery to be deferred.
18788 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18789 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18791 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18792 means of the setting
18796 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18797 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18798 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18800 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18801 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18802 controls what happens next.
18805 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18806 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18807 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18808 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18809 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18810 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18811 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18812 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18814 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18815 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18816 applies to all of them.
18820 .option pass_router routers string unset
18821 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18822 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18823 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18824 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18825 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18826 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18827 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18828 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18829 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18830 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18834 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18835 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18836 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18837 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18838 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18839 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18841 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18842 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18843 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18844 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18848 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18849 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18850 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18851 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18852 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18853 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18854 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18856 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18857 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
18858 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18859 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18860 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18862 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18863 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18864 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18865 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18866 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18869 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18870 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18873 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18874 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18875 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18876 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18877 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18878 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18879 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18880 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
18882 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18883 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18884 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18885 operates as follows:
18887 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18888 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18889 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18890 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18893 require_files = mail:/some/file
18894 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18896 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18897 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18899 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18900 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18901 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18902 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18904 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18905 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18906 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18907 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18908 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18910 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18911 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18912 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18913 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18914 check again in that process.
18916 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18917 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18918 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18919 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18920 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
18921 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18922 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18924 require_files = +/some/file
18926 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18927 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18928 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18932 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18933 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18934 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18935 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18936 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18937 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18938 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18939 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18942 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18943 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18945 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
18946 &%check_local_user%&,
18949 &%local_part_prefix%&,
18950 &%local_part_suffix%&,
18954 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18955 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18958 Failing to set this option when it is needed
18959 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
18960 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
18962 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18963 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18964 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18968 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18969 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18970 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18972 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18973 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18974 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18975 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18976 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18977 cause the router to defer.
18979 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18980 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18982 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18984 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18985 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18987 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18988 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18989 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18990 of these values that is set:
18993 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18995 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18997 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18999 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19002 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19003 router, but not for the transport.
19007 .option self routers string freeze
19008 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19009 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19010 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19011 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19012 and &(manualroute)& routers.
19013 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19015 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19016 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19017 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19018 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19019 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19021 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19022 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19023 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19024 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19025 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19030 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19032 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19033 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19034 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19035 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19037 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19038 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19039 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19044 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19045 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19046 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19047 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19048 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19049 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19055 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19056 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19057 be passed to the next router.
19060 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19063 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
19064 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19065 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19066 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19067 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19068 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19073 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19074 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
19075 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19076 address matches something on the list.
19077 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19080 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19081 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19082 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19083 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19084 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19085 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19086 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19091 .option set routers "string list" unset
19092 .cindex router variables
19093 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19094 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19095 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19098 Each list-element given must be of the form $"name = value"$
19099 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19100 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19101 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19102 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19104 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19105 The variables can be used by the router options
19106 (not including any preconditions)
19107 and by the transport.
19108 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19109 Varible use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19111 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19112 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19116 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19117 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
19118 .cindex "packet radio"
19119 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19120 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19121 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19122 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19123 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19124 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19125 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19126 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19128 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19129 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19130 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19131 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19132 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19133 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19134 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19135 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19136 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19137 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19139 translate_ip_address = \
19140 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19143 The file would contain lines like
19145 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
19146 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19148 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19153 .option transport routers string&!! unset
19154 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19155 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19156 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19157 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19158 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19159 delivery is deferred.
19161 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19162 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19163 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19167 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19168 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19169 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19170 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19171 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19172 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19173 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19174 overridden by a setting on the transport.
19175 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19176 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19177 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19183 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19184 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19185 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19186 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19187 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19188 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19189 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19190 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19191 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19192 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19194 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19195 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19196 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19197 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19198 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19200 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19206 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19207 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19208 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19209 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19210 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19211 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19212 delivery to be deferred.
19214 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19215 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19216 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19217 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19218 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19219 sometimes true and sometimes false).
19221 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19222 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19223 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19224 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19225 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19226 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19227 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19228 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19230 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19231 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19232 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19233 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19234 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19235 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19236 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19237 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19238 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19239 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19241 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19242 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19243 subsequent routers.
19246 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
19247 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19248 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19249 .cindex "transport" "local"
19250 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19251 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19252 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19253 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19254 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19255 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19256 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19257 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19258 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19259 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19260 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19261 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19265 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
19266 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19267 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19270 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19271 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19273 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19274 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19275 delivering in cutthrough mode or
19276 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19277 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19278 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19279 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19281 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19282 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19283 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19287 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19288 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19290 delivering in cutthrough mode
19291 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19292 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19294 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19297 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19298 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19299 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19300 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19302 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19303 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19304 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19311 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19312 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19314 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19315 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
19316 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19317 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19318 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19319 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19320 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19321 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19322 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19326 domains = mydomain.example
19328 transport = local_delivery
19330 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19331 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19332 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19333 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19340 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19341 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19343 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19344 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19345 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19346 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19347 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19348 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19350 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19351 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19352 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19353 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19356 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19357 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19358 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19359 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19360 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19361 generic option, the router declines.
19363 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19364 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19365 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19367 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19368 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19369 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19370 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19371 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19372 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19375 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19376 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19377 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19378 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19379 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19380 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19382 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19383 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19384 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19385 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19386 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19387 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19388 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19389 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19390 case routing fails.
19393 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19394 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19395 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19396 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19397 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19399 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19400 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19402 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19404 The domain does not exist in DNS
19406 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19407 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19408 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19410 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19412 MX record points to a non-existent host.
19414 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19415 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19417 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19418 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19420 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19421 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19423 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19424 not be found in the MX records (see below)
19430 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19431 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19432 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19434 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19435 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19436 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19437 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19438 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19439 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19440 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19443 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19444 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19445 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19446 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19447 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19448 required. For example,
19452 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19453 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19454 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19455 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19456 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19459 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19460 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19461 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19462 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19463 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19464 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19466 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19467 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19468 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19469 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19470 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19471 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19472 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19473 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19475 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19476 when there is a DNS lookup error.
19481 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19482 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
19483 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19484 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19485 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19486 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19487 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19488 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19492 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19493 .cindex IPv6 disabling
19494 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19495 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19496 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19497 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19498 only A records are used.
19500 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19501 .cindex IPv4 preference
19502 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19503 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19504 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19505 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19506 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19508 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19509 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19510 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19511 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19512 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19513 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19514 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19517 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19519 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19520 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19521 the address record.
19524 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19525 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19526 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19527 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19532 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19533 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19534 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19535 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19536 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19537 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19538 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19539 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19540 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19545 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19546 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19547 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19548 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19549 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19550 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19551 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19552 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19553 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19554 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19555 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19557 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19558 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19561 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19562 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19563 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19564 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19565 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19569 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19570 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19571 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19572 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19573 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19574 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19575 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19576 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19578 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19579 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19580 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19581 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19582 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19583 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19584 without processing them independently,
19585 provided the following conditions are met:
19588 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19589 &%headers_remove%&.
19591 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19598 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19599 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19600 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19601 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19602 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19603 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19604 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19605 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19606 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19607 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19609 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19610 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19615 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19616 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19617 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19618 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19623 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19624 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19625 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19626 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19629 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19631 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19632 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19633 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19634 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19635 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19636 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19639 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19640 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19641 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19642 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19643 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19645 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19646 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19647 such as that implied by
19651 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19652 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19653 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19654 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19665 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19667 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19668 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19669 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19670 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19671 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19672 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19673 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19674 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19675 router handles the address
19679 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19680 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19681 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19683 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19685 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19686 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19688 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19689 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19690 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19691 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19693 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19694 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19695 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19696 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19700 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19701 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19703 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19704 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19705 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19706 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19707 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19708 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19711 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19713 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19715 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19716 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19717 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19718 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19719 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19720 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19721 must not be specified for it.
19723 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19724 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19725 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19726 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19727 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19728 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19729 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19732 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19733 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19734 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19735 delivery to the address is deferred.
19738 .option port iplookup integer 0
19739 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19740 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19744 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19745 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19746 protocols is to be used.
19749 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19750 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19753 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19755 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19756 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19759 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19760 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19761 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19762 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19763 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19764 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19765 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19766 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19769 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19770 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19771 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19772 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19773 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19774 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19775 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19776 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19777 following could be used:
19779 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19780 reroute = $local_part@$1
19783 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19784 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19785 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19786 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19791 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19792 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19794 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19795 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19796 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19797 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19798 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19799 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19800 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19801 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19802 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19803 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19805 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19806 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19807 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19808 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19809 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19810 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19811 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19814 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19815 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19816 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19817 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19818 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19819 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19820 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19823 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19824 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19825 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19826 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19827 below, following the list of private options.
19830 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19832 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19833 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19835 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19836 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19838 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19839 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19840 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19841 of the following values:
19850 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19851 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19852 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19855 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19856 router only if &%more%& is true.
19858 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19859 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19860 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19861 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19863 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19864 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19865 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19868 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19869 .cindex "randomized host list"
19870 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19871 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19872 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19873 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19874 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19875 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19876 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19877 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19879 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19880 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19881 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19882 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19884 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19886 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19887 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19888 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19889 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19890 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19893 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19894 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19895 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19898 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19900 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19901 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19905 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19906 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19907 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19908 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19911 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19912 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19913 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19914 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19915 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19916 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19917 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19918 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19920 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19921 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19922 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19923 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19924 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19925 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19926 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19927 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19932 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19933 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19934 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19935 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19936 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19937 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19939 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19941 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19945 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19946 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19948 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19949 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19950 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19951 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19952 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19953 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19954 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19955 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19956 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19957 in a &%route_list%&).
19959 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19960 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19961 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19962 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19966 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19967 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19968 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19969 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19970 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19971 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19972 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19975 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19976 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19978 This data can be accessed by setting
19980 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19982 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19983 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19984 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19985 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19986 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19991 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19992 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19993 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19994 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19995 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
19996 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
19997 The format of each item
19998 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19999 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20001 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20002 variables are set during its expansion:
20005 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20006 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20007 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20009 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20012 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20014 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20017 .vindex "&$value$&"
20018 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20019 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20021 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20025 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20026 semicolon is the default route list separator.
20030 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20031 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
20032 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
20033 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20034 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20035 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20038 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20039 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20040 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20042 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20043 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20046 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20047 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20048 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20049 number follows. For example:
20051 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20055 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20056 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20057 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20058 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20059 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20062 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20063 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20064 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20065 records in the DNS. For example:
20067 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20069 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20072 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20074 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20075 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20076 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20077 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20078 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20079 happens is controlled by the
20080 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20081 &%self%& option of the router.
20083 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20084 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20085 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20086 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20087 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20088 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20089 defined by MX preferences.
20091 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20092 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20093 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20095 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20096 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20097 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20098 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20100 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20101 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20104 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20105 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20106 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20108 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20109 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20113 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20114 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20115 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20116 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20117 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20118 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20119 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20122 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20123 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20125 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20126 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20128 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20129 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20130 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20132 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20133 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20134 timeout), delivery is deferred.
20136 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20138 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20143 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20144 domain2 host4:host5
20146 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20147 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20148 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20149 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20152 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20153 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20154 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20155 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20158 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20159 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20164 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20165 &%host_find_failed%& option.
20168 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20169 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20173 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20174 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20175 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20178 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
20179 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20180 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20181 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20183 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20185 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20186 your first router something like this:
20189 driver = manualroute
20190 domains = !+local_domains
20191 transport = remote_smtp
20192 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20194 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20195 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20196 they are tried in order
20197 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20198 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20201 driver = manualroute
20202 transport = remote_smtp
20203 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20205 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20206 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20207 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20208 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20209 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20210 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20211 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20212 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20215 .cindex "mail hub example"
20216 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20217 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20218 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20219 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20220 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20221 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20222 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20223 lookup is easier to manage.
20225 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20226 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20230 driver = manualroute
20231 transport = remote_smtp
20232 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20234 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20235 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20236 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20237 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20238 domain can be used to find the host:
20241 driver = manualroute
20242 transport = remote_smtp
20243 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20245 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20246 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20247 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20251 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20252 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20253 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20254 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20255 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20256 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20259 driver = manualroute
20260 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20261 route_list = saved.domain.example
20263 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20264 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20265 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20268 driver = manualroute
20270 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20271 *.saved.domain2.example \
20272 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20275 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20277 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20278 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20279 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20280 the address if the lookup fails.
20283 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20284 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20285 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20286 one way it can be done:
20292 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20293 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20294 return_fail_output = true
20299 driver = manualroute
20301 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20303 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20305 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20307 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20308 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20309 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20311 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
20312 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
20321 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20322 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20324 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20325 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20326 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20327 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
20328 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20329 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20330 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20331 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20332 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20333 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20335 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20337 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20338 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20339 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20340 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20341 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20344 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
20345 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20346 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20347 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20348 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20349 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20352 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
20353 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20354 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20355 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20356 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20357 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20358 not set, a value for the gid also.
20360 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20361 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20362 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20363 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20364 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20365 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20369 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
20370 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20371 before running the command.
20374 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20375 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20376 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20380 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20381 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20382 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20383 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20384 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20387 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20390 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20391 &%no_more%& is set.
20393 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20394 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20395 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20396 included in the SMTP response.
20398 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20399 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20400 included in any SMTP response.
20402 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20404 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20405 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20407 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20408 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20409 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20412 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20413 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20416 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20417 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20419 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20420 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20421 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20422 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20424 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20425 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20426 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20427 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20428 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20430 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20431 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20432 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20433 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20434 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20436 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
20437 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20438 variable. For example, this return line
20440 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20442 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20443 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20444 .ecindex IIDquerou1
20445 .ecindex IIDquerou2
20450 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20451 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20453 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20454 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20455 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20456 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20457 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20458 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20459 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20460 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20461 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20462 redirected in several different ways:
20465 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20468 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20470 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20472 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20474 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20476 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20478 It can be discarded.
20481 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20482 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20483 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20484 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20486 If success DSNs have been requested
20487 .cindex "DSN" "success"
20488 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20489 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20493 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20494 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20495 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20496 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20497 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20498 aliases, in a configuration like this:
20502 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20504 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20505 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20506 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20507 cause delivery to be deferred.
20509 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20510 &_.forward_& files, like this:
20515 file = $home/.forward
20518 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20519 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20520 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20521 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20526 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20527 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20528 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20529 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20532 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20533 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20534 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20535 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20537 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20538 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20539 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20540 saves some resources.
20548 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20549 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20550 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20551 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20552 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20555 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20556 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20557 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20558 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20559 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20560 document is intended for use by end users.
20562 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20563 described in the next section.
20566 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20567 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20568 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20569 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20570 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20574 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20575 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20576 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20577 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20578 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20579 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20580 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20581 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20582 commas or newlines.
20583 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20586 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20587 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20588 next newline character is ignored.
20590 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20591 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20592 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20593 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20596 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20597 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20598 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20599 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20600 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20601 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20604 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20608 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20609 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20610 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20611 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20612 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20613 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20614 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20615 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20616 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20617 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20618 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20620 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20621 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20622 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20623 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20624 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20626 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20628 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20629 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20630 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20631 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20632 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20635 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20636 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20637 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20638 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20639 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20641 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20642 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20647 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20648 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20651 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20653 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20654 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20655 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20656 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20657 should really contain
20659 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20661 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20662 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20663 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20667 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20668 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20669 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20672 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20673 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20674 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20675 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20676 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20677 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20678 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20680 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20681 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20682 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20683 in double quotes, for example:
20685 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20687 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20688 quote just the command. An item such as
20690 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20692 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20694 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20695 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20696 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20697 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20698 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20699 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20700 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20701 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20702 an &%accept%& router.
20705 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20706 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20707 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20708 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20710 /home/world/minbari
20712 is treated as a filename, but
20714 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20716 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20717 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20718 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20719 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20721 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20722 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20724 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20725 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20726 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20727 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20730 .cindex "included address list"
20731 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20732 If an item is of the form
20734 :include:<path name>
20736 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20737 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20738 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20739 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20740 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20741 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20743 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20745 It must be given as
20747 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20750 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20751 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20752 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20753 .cindex "black hole"
20754 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20755 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20756 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20757 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20761 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20762 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20763 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20765 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20766 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20767 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20768 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20772 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20773 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20774 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20775 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20776 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20777 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20778 redirection items of the form
20783 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20784 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20785 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20786 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20788 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20790 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20792 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20793 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20795 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20796 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20797 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20799 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20800 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20801 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20802 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20803 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20804 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20805 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20806 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20807 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20810 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20811 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20812 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20813 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20815 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20816 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20817 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20818 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20819 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20821 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20822 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20823 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20824 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20825 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20829 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20830 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20831 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20832 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20833 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20834 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20835 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20839 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20840 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20841 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20842 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20843 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20844 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20845 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20846 aliasing scheme of the type
20848 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20852 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20853 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20854 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20857 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20858 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20860 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20861 the pipes are distinct.
20865 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20866 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20867 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20868 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20869 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20870 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20871 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20872 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20873 can be used to avoid this.
20876 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20877 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20878 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20879 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20880 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20881 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20882 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20886 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20888 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20889 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20892 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20893 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20894 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20897 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20898 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20899 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20900 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20903 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20904 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20905 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20906 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20907 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20908 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20909 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20911 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20912 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20915 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20916 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20917 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20918 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20919 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20923 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20924 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20925 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20926 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20927 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20928 let ordinary users do.
20932 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20933 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20934 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20935 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20936 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20937 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20939 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20940 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20941 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20942 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20943 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20944 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20946 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20948 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20949 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20950 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20951 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20952 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20953 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20954 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20955 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20958 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20959 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20960 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20961 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20962 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20963 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20964 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20965 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20969 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20970 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20971 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20972 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20973 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20974 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20977 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20978 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20979 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20980 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20981 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20982 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20984 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20985 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20986 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20988 data = #Exim filter\n\
20989 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20991 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20992 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20993 choice into a newline.
20996 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20997 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20998 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20999 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21000 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21003 .option file redirect string&!! unset
21004 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21005 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21006 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21007 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21008 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21009 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21010 entirely of comments), the router declines.
21012 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21013 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21014 runs a check on the containing directory,
21015 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21016 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21017 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21018 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21019 not, the router declines.
21022 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21023 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21024 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21025 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21026 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21027 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21028 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21031 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21032 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21033 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21034 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21035 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21038 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21039 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21040 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21041 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21045 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21046 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21047 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21048 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21049 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21054 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21055 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21056 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21057 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21058 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21059 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21060 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21061 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21062 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21063 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21064 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21067 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21068 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21069 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21070 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21071 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21074 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21075 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21076 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21077 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21078 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21079 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21081 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21082 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21083 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21084 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21085 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21086 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21087 &_.forward_& files).
21090 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21091 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21092 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21093 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21094 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21097 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21098 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21099 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21100 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21101 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21102 of the embedded Perl support.
21105 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21106 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21107 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21108 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21109 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21112 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21113 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21114 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21115 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21116 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21119 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21120 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21121 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21122 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21123 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21124 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21125 &%one_time%& is set.
21128 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21129 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21130 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21131 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21132 to make use of &%run%& items.
21135 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21136 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21137 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21138 If this option is true, items of the form
21140 :include:<path name>
21142 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21145 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21146 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21147 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21148 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21149 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21150 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21151 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21154 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21155 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21156 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21157 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21158 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21161 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21162 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21163 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21164 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21165 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21170 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21171 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21172 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21173 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21174 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21175 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21176 bounce may well quote the generated address.
21179 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21181 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21182 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21183 file did not exist.
21186 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21188 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21189 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21190 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21192 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21193 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21194 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21195 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21196 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21197 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21198 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21199 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21203 .option include_directory redirect string unset
21204 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21205 redirection list must start with this directory.
21208 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21209 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21210 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21213 .option one_time redirect boolean false
21214 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21215 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21216 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21217 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21218 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21219 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21220 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21221 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21222 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21223 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21224 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21225 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21226 before they subscribed.
21228 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21229 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21230 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21231 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21234 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21235 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21236 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21237 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21239 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21240 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21241 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21243 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21246 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21247 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21248 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21249 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21250 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21254 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
21255 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21256 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21257 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21258 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21259 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21260 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21261 See &%check_owner%& above.
21264 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21265 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21266 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21267 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21270 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21271 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21272 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21273 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21274 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21275 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21276 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21279 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21280 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21281 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21282 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21283 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21284 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21285 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21286 &$qualify_recipient$&.
21288 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21289 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21290 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21293 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21294 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21295 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21296 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21297 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21298 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21299 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21300 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21301 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21302 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21305 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21306 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21307 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21308 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21309 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21310 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21313 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21314 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21315 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21316 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21317 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21318 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21321 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
21322 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21323 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21324 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21325 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21328 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21329 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21330 :subaddress part of an address.
21332 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21333 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21334 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21335 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21338 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21339 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21340 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21341 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21342 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21343 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21344 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21348 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21349 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
21350 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21351 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
21352 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21353 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21354 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21355 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21356 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21357 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21358 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21359 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21360 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21361 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21362 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21363 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21365 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21366 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21367 the following routers.
21369 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21370 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21371 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21372 so it is passed to the following routers.
21374 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21375 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21376 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21377 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21379 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21380 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21381 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21382 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21388 file = $home/.forward
21389 file_transport = address_file
21390 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21391 reply_transport = address_reply
21394 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21395 syntax_errors_text = \
21396 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21397 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21398 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21399 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21400 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21401 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21402 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21403 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21404 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21405 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21407 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21408 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21409 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21414 local_part_prefix = real-
21415 transport = local_delivery
21417 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21418 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21420 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21421 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21425 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21426 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21429 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21430 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21431 .ecindex IIDredrou1
21432 .ecindex IIDredrou2
21439 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21440 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21442 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21443 "Environment for local transports"
21444 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21445 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21446 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21447 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21448 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21449 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21450 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21452 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21453 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21454 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21455 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21457 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21458 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21459 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21460 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21461 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21465 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21466 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21467 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21468 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21469 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21470 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21471 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21474 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21475 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21479 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21481 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21482 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21483 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21484 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21489 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21490 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21491 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21492 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21493 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21494 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21495 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21496 group (set by the transport). For example:
21499 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21503 transport = group_delivery
21506 # This transport overrides the group
21508 driver = appendfile
21509 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21512 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21513 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21514 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21517 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21518 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21519 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21520 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21521 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21522 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21524 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21525 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21526 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21527 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21528 original gid is also used.
21530 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21531 following that is set is used:
21534 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21536 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21538 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21539 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21541 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21543 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21544 the uid is the creator's uid;
21546 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21549 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21550 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21551 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21552 The first of the following that is set is used:
21555 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21557 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21559 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21561 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21566 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21567 &%never_users%& list.
21573 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21574 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21575 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21576 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21577 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21578 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21579 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21580 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21581 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21582 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21585 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21587 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21589 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21591 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21594 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21597 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21599 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21603 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21604 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21605 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21609 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21610 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21611 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21612 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21613 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21614 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21615 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21616 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21617 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21618 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21619 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21620 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21621 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21622 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21631 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21633 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21634 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21635 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21636 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21637 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21640 .option body_only transports boolean false
21641 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21642 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21643 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21644 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21645 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21646 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21647 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21648 automatically suppress them.
21651 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21652 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21653 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21654 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21655 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21656 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21659 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21660 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21661 deliveries by the transport or for any
21662 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21663 what you are doing.
21666 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21667 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21668 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21669 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21671 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21672 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21673 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21674 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21675 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21676 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21678 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21679 transport and the router that called it.
21681 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21682 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21683 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21684 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21685 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21686 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21687 safely be resent to other recipients.
21690 .option driver transports string unset
21691 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21692 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21695 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21696 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21697 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21698 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21699 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21700 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21701 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21702 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21703 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21704 resent to other recipients.
21707 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21709 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21710 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21713 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21714 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21715 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21716 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21717 &%user%& (see below).
21720 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21721 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21722 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21723 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21724 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21725 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21726 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21727 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21728 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21729 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21730 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21732 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21733 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21736 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21737 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21738 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21739 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21740 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21741 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21742 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21743 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21746 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21747 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21748 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21749 This option specifies a list of header names,
21750 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
21751 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21752 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21754 Each list item is separately expanded.
21755 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21756 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21757 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21759 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21760 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21762 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21763 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21764 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21768 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21769 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21770 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21771 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21772 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21773 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21774 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21775 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21778 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21781 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21782 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21783 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21784 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21785 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21786 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21787 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21788 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21789 change envelope recipients at this time.
21792 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21793 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21795 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21796 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21797 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21798 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21799 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21800 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21801 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21805 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21806 .cindex "additional groups"
21807 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21808 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21809 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21810 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21811 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21814 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21815 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21816 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21817 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21818 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21819 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21820 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21821 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21823 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21824 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21825 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21826 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21827 Obviously there is scope for
21828 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21829 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21831 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21832 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21833 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21834 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21835 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21838 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21839 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21840 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21841 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21842 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21843 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21844 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21845 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21846 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21847 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21848 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21849 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21850 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21855 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21856 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21857 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21858 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21859 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21860 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21861 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21862 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21865 local_part_prefix = *-
21867 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21870 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21872 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21873 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21874 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21875 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21876 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21879 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21880 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21881 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21882 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21883 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21884 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21885 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21886 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21887 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21889 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21890 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21891 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21892 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21894 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21895 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21896 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21899 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21900 .cindex "envelope sender"
21901 .cindex "envelope from"
21902 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21903 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21904 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21905 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21906 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21907 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21908 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21909 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21910 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21912 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21913 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21915 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21916 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21917 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21918 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21919 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21920 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21921 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21923 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21924 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21925 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21926 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21927 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21931 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21932 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21933 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21934 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21935 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21936 have easy access to it.
21938 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21939 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21940 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21941 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21942 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21946 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21947 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21950 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21951 .cindex "shadow transport"
21952 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21953 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21954 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21956 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21957 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21958 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21959 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21960 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21961 cause a log line to be written.
21963 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21964 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21965 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21966 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21967 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21970 ST=<shadow transport name>
21972 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21973 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21974 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21975 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21976 headers that some sites insist on.
21979 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21980 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21981 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21982 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21983 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21984 individual users or via a system filter.
21985 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21987 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21988 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21989 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21990 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21991 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21993 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21994 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21995 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21996 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21997 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21998 &(pipe)& transports.
22000 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22001 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22002 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22003 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22004 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22006 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22007 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22008 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22009 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22011 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22012 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22013 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22014 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22015 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22016 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22018 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22019 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22020 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22021 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22022 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22023 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22024 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22025 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22027 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22028 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22029 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22030 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22031 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22032 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22033 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22034 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22035 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22036 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22039 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22040 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22041 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22042 which the message is being sent. For example:
22044 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22045 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
22048 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22049 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22050 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22052 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22053 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22054 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22057 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22059 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22060 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22061 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22062 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22063 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22064 Exim tried to expand the first one.
22066 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22067 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22068 arguments. Consider this example:
22070 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22071 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22073 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22074 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22076 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22077 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22081 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22082 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22083 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22084 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22085 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22086 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22087 bounced from a transport filter.
22089 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22090 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22091 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22094 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22095 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22096 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22097 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22098 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22099 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22100 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22101 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22102 becomes a temporary error.
22105 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22106 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22107 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22108 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22109 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22110 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22111 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22114 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22115 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22116 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22118 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22119 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22120 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22121 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22123 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22124 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22125 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22132 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22133 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22135 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22137 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22138 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22139 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22140 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22141 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22142 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22143 copy of the message is delivered each time.
22145 .cindex "batched local delivery"
22146 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22147 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22148 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22149 local transport, for example:
22152 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22153 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22154 recipients saves space.
22156 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22157 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22159 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22160 to a scanner program or
22161 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22165 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22166 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22167 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22169 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22170 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22171 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22172 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22173 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22174 to certain conditions:
22177 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22178 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22179 batching is possible.
22181 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22182 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22183 addresses with the same domain are batched.
22185 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22186 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22187 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22188 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22189 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22192 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22193 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22194 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22198 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22199 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22200 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22201 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22202 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22203 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22204 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22207 escape_string = ".."
22209 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22210 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22211 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22213 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22214 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22215 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22216 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22217 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22218 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22220 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22221 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22222 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22223 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22224 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22225 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22226 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22227 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22228 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22233 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22234 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22236 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22237 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22238 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22239 .cindex "directory creation"
22240 .cindex "creating directories"
22241 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22242 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22243 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22244 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22245 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22246 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22247 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22248 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22249 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22250 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22252 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22253 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22254 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22257 .cindex "quota" "system"
22258 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22259 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22260 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22262 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22263 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22264 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22265 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22267 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22268 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22271 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22272 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22273 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22274 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22279 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22280 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22281 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22282 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22283 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22285 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22286 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22287 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22288 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22289 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22290 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22291 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22292 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22293 operation. There are two cases:
22296 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22297 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22298 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22299 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22300 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22301 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22302 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22304 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22305 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22306 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22310 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22311 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22312 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22313 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22318 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22320 require "fileinto";
22321 fileinto "folder23";
22323 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22324 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22325 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22326 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22327 way of handling this requirement:
22329 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22330 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22331 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22333 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22337 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22338 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22339 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22341 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22342 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22343 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22344 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22345 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22346 path to the transport.
22348 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22349 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22354 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22355 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22359 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22360 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22361 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22362 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22363 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22364 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22365 delivery is deferred.
22368 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22369 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22370 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22371 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22372 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22373 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22374 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22375 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22378 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22379 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22380 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22381 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22385 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22386 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22389 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
22390 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22391 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22392 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22393 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22396 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22397 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22398 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22399 process is running.
22402 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22403 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22404 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22405 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22406 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22407 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22408 contains is significant.
22410 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22411 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22412 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22413 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22414 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22416 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22417 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22418 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22419 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22420 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22421 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22423 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22424 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22425 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22426 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22428 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22429 .cindex "directory creation"
22430 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22431 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22432 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22434 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22435 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22436 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22437 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22438 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22442 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22443 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22444 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22445 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22446 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22449 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22450 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22451 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22452 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22453 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22454 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22455 &%file_must_exist%&.
22458 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22459 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22460 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22461 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22463 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22464 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22465 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22466 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22467 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22470 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22472 .vindex "&$inode$&"
22473 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22474 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22475 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22477 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22479 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22480 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22484 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22485 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22486 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22489 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22490 See &%check_string%& above.
22493 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
22494 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22495 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22496 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22497 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22498 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22501 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22502 .cindex "locking files"
22503 .cindex "lock files"
22504 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22505 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22507 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22508 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22511 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22512 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22515 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22516 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22517 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22518 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22519 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22520 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22524 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22525 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22526 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22527 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22528 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22529 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22530 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22531 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22532 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22535 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22536 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22538 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22539 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22540 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22541 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22542 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22543 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22544 delivery is deferred.
22547 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22548 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22549 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22550 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22553 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22554 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22555 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22556 .cindex "locking files"
22557 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22558 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22559 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22560 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22561 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22562 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22563 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22564 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22566 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22567 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22568 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22569 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22571 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22572 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22575 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22577 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22578 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22579 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22581 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22582 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22584 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22587 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22588 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22589 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22590 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22593 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22594 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22595 for details of locking.
22598 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22599 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22600 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22603 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22604 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22605 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22608 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22609 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22610 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22611 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22612 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22615 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22616 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22617 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22618 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22619 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22620 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22621 external source that maintains the data.
22624 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22625 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22626 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22627 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22628 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22629 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22630 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22631 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22635 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22636 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22637 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22638 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22639 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22640 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22641 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22642 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22643 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22644 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22647 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22648 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22649 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22650 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22651 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22652 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22653 calculation. The default value is:
22655 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22657 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22658 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22660 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22662 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22664 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22665 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22666 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22667 directly into that directory.
22670 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22671 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22672 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22675 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22676 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22677 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22680 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22681 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22682 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22683 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22684 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22685 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22686 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22687 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22689 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22690 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22691 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22692 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22693 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22694 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22695 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22696 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22697 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22698 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22701 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22702 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22703 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22704 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22705 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22706 below for further details.
22709 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22710 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22711 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22714 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22715 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22716 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22719 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22720 .cindex "locking files"
22721 .cindex "file" "locking"
22722 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22723 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22724 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22725 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22726 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22727 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22728 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22730 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22731 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22732 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22739 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22740 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22741 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22742 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22743 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22744 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22745 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22746 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22748 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22749 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22750 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22751 append messages to it.
22754 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22755 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22756 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22757 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22758 in which case it is:
22760 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22761 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22763 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22764 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22766 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22767 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22768 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22769 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22774 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22775 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22777 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22778 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22779 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22780 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22781 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22782 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22783 value, and this option is ignored.
22786 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22787 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22788 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22789 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22790 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22793 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22794 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22795 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22796 on users about incoming mail.
22799 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22800 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22801 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22802 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22803 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22804 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22805 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22806 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22807 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22809 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22810 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22811 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22813 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22814 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22815 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22816 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22817 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22818 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22820 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22821 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22822 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22823 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22824 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22827 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22828 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22830 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22832 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22833 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22834 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22835 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22836 system quota failures.
22838 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22839 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22840 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22841 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22842 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22843 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22844 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22845 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22846 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22847 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22850 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22851 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22852 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22853 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22854 delivery directory.
22857 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22858 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22859 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22860 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22861 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22864 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22865 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22867 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22868 See &%quota%& above.
22871 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22872 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22873 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22874 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22875 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
22876 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22877 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22879 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22880 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22881 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22882 the file length to the filename. For example:
22884 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22885 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22887 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22888 number of lines in the message.
22890 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22891 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22892 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
22894 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22897 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
22898 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
22899 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
22900 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
22901 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
22902 as is used to adjust the effective size.
22906 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22907 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22908 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22910 quota_warn_message = "\
22911 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22912 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22913 This message is automatically created \
22914 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22915 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22916 a warning threshold that is\n\
22917 set by the system administrator.\n"
22921 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22922 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22923 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22924 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22925 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22926 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22927 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22928 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22929 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22933 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22935 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22936 percent sign is ignored.
22938 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22939 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22940 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22941 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22942 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22943 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22945 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22947 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22948 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22951 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22952 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22956 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22957 .cindex "envelope from"
22958 .cindex "envelope sender"
22959 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22960 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22961 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22962 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22963 for details of batch SMTP.
22966 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22967 .cindex "carriage return"
22969 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22970 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22971 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22972 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22974 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22975 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22976 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22977 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22978 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22979 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22982 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22983 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22984 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22985 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22986 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22987 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22990 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22991 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22992 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22993 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22994 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22996 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22997 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22998 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22999 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23001 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23002 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23003 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23004 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23005 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23008 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23009 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23012 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23013 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23014 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23015 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23016 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23017 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23018 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23020 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23021 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23022 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23023 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23026 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23027 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23028 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23031 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23032 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23033 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23034 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23035 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23036 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23037 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23038 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23039 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23041 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23042 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23043 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23044 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23049 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23050 .cindex "appending to a file"
23051 .cindex "file" "appending"
23052 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23055 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23059 .cindex "directory creation"
23060 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23061 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23062 &%directory_mode%& option.
23065 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23066 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23070 .cindex "file" "locking"
23071 .cindex "locking files"
23072 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23073 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23074 reliably over NFS, as follows:
23077 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23078 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23079 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23081 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23083 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23084 Unlink the hitching post name.
23086 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23087 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23088 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23089 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23091 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23092 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23093 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23094 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23095 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23096 it before trying again.
23100 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23101 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23102 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23105 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23106 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23107 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23108 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23109 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23110 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23111 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23112 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23113 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23117 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23118 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23119 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23120 delivery is deferred.
23123 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23124 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23125 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23129 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23130 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23131 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23134 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23135 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23136 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23139 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23140 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23141 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23142 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23143 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23144 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23145 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23146 that prevents link following.
23149 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23150 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23151 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23152 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23153 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23156 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23159 .cindex "file" "locking"
23160 .cindex "locking files"
23161 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23162 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23163 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23164 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23165 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23167 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23169 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23170 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23171 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23173 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23174 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23175 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23177 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23178 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23179 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23180 delivery is deferred.
23182 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23183 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23184 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23185 immediately. It retries up to
23187 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23189 times (rounded up).
23192 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23193 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23196 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23197 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23198 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23199 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23200 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23201 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23202 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23203 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23204 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23205 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23207 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23208 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23209 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23210 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23211 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23212 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23213 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23215 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23216 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23217 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23218 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23221 .cindex "maildir format"
23222 .cindex "mailstore format"
23223 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23224 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23225 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23226 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23227 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23229 .cindex "directory creation"
23230 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23231 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23232 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23233 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23234 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23235 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23240 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23241 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23242 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23243 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23244 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23245 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23246 &_new_& subdirectory.
23248 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23249 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23250 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23251 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23252 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23253 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23254 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23256 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23257 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23258 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23259 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23260 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23261 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23262 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23263 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23265 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23266 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23267 folders. Consider this example:
23269 maildir_format = true
23270 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23271 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23272 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23273 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23275 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23276 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23277 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23278 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23279 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23280 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23282 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23283 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23284 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23285 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23286 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23288 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23289 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23290 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23292 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23293 .cindex "maildir++"
23294 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23295 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23296 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23297 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23298 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23299 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23300 amount of space used.
23302 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23303 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23304 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23305 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23306 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23307 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23312 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23313 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23314 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23315 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23316 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23317 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23320 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
23321 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23322 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23323 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23324 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23325 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23326 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23327 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23328 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23329 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23330 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23331 backwards compatibility).
23333 For one common implementation, you might set:
23335 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23337 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23339 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23340 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23341 &[stat()]& each message file.
23344 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23345 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23346 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23347 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23348 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23349 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23350 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23351 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23352 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23354 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23355 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23356 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23357 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23358 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23359 need to know the quota.
23361 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23362 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23364 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23365 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23366 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23370 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23371 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23372 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23373 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23374 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23375 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23376 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23377 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23379 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23380 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23381 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23382 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23383 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23384 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23386 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23387 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23388 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23389 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23390 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23391 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23393 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23394 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23395 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23396 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23399 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23400 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23401 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23402 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23403 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23405 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23407 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23408 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23409 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23410 .ecindex IIDapptra1
23411 .ecindex IIDapptra2
23418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23421 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23422 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23423 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23424 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23425 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23426 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23427 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23428 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23430 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23431 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23432 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23433 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23434 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23437 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23438 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23439 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23440 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23441 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23443 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23444 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23445 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23446 transport is run as a consequence of a
23448 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23449 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23450 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23451 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23452 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23453 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23455 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23456 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23457 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23458 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23460 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23461 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23462 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23463 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23464 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23465 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23466 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23468 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23469 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23470 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23471 the transport defers.
23472 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23473 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23475 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23476 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23477 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23478 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23480 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23481 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23482 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23483 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23484 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23485 problems. They are just discarded.
23489 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23490 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23492 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23493 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23494 message when the message is specified by the transport.
23497 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23498 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23499 when the message is specified by the transport.
23502 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
23503 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23504 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23505 string comes first.
23508 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23509 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23510 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23513 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23514 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23515 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23518 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
23519 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23520 specified by the transport.
23523 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23524 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23525 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23526 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23529 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
23530 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23531 the message is specified by the transport.
23534 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23535 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23539 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23540 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23541 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23542 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23543 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23547 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23548 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23549 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23550 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23552 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23553 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23554 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23555 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23556 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23557 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23558 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23561 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23562 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23563 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23564 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23565 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23567 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23568 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23569 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23570 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23571 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23572 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23575 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23576 See &%once%& above.
23579 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23580 See &%once%& above.
23581 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23584 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23585 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23586 specified by the transport.
23589 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23590 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23591 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23592 configuration option.
23595 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23596 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23597 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23598 automatic responses. For example:
23600 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23602 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23603 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23604 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23605 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23610 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23611 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23612 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23613 the text comes first.
23616 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23617 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23618 when the message is specified by the transport.
23619 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23620 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23625 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23626 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23628 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23629 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23630 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23631 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23632 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23633 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23635 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23636 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23637 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23638 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23639 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23640 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23644 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23645 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23646 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23649 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23650 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23653 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23654 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23655 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23656 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23657 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23660 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23661 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23662 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23663 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23664 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23665 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23668 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23669 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23670 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23671 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23672 in its response to the LHLO command.
23674 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23675 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23676 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23677 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23680 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23681 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23682 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23683 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23688 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23692 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23693 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23697 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23698 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23700 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23701 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23702 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23703 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23704 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23705 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23706 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23707 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23711 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23712 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23713 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23714 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23715 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23717 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23718 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23719 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23720 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23721 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23722 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23723 that are routed to the transport.
23725 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23726 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23727 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23728 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23729 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23730 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23731 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23735 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23736 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23737 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23739 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23740 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23741 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23742 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23743 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23744 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23745 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23748 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23749 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23750 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23751 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23752 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23753 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23754 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23759 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23760 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23761 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23762 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23763 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23764 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23765 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23766 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23767 &"local delivery failed"&.
23769 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23770 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23771 will be sent as normal.
23773 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23774 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23775 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23776 apply in this case.
23778 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23779 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23780 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23781 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23783 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23784 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23785 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23786 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23787 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23788 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23789 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23794 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23795 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23796 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23797 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23798 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23801 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23802 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23803 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23804 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23806 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23807 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23808 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23809 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23810 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23812 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23814 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23815 arguments. You have to write
23817 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23819 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23820 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23821 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23822 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23823 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23824 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23827 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23830 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23831 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23832 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23833 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23834 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
23835 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23836 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23837 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23838 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23839 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23840 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23842 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
23843 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23844 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23845 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23846 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23847 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23848 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23849 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23851 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23852 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23853 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23854 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23855 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23856 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23857 control what is done with it.
23859 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23860 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23861 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23862 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23863 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23864 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23865 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23866 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23867 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23868 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23869 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23873 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23874 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23875 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23876 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23877 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23878 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23879 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23880 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23882 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23883 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23884 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23885 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23886 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23887 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23888 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23889 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23890 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23891 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23892 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23893 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23894 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23895 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23896 &`USER `& see below
23898 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23899 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23900 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23901 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23902 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23903 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23904 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23907 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23908 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23909 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23913 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23914 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23915 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23916 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23919 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23920 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23924 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23925 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23926 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23927 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23928 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23929 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23930 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23931 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23932 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23933 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23934 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23937 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23939 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23940 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23941 &%use_shell%& is set.
23944 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23945 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23948 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23949 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23950 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23953 .option check_string pipe string unset
23954 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23955 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23956 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23957 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23958 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23959 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23960 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23964 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23965 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23966 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23967 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23968 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23969 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23970 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23973 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23974 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23975 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23976 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23977 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23978 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23979 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23982 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23983 See &%check_string%& above.
23986 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23987 .cindex "exec failure"
23988 .cindex "failure of exec"
23989 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23990 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23991 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23992 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23993 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23996 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23997 .cindex "signal exit"
23998 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23999 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24000 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24001 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24004 .option force_command pipe boolean false
24005 .cindex "force command"
24006 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24007 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24008 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24009 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24010 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24011 command. For example:
24013 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24017 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24018 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24019 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24022 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24023 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24024 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24025 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24026 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24027 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24029 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24030 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24033 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24034 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24035 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24036 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24037 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24038 written to the main log.
24041 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24042 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24043 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24044 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24045 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24046 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24050 .option log_output pipe boolean false
24051 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24052 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24053 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24054 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24057 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
24058 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24059 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24060 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24061 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24062 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24063 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24064 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24067 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24068 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24069 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24072 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24076 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
24077 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24078 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24079 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24080 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24085 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24086 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24089 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24090 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24091 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24092 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24096 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24097 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24100 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24101 This option is expanded and
24102 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24103 variable of the subprocess.
24104 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24105 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24106 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24109 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24110 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24111 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24112 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24113 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24114 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24115 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24116 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24117 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24120 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24121 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24122 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24123 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24124 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24125 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24126 accept the message is used.
24129 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24130 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24131 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24132 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24133 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24134 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24137 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24138 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24139 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24140 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24141 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24142 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24143 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24147 .option return_output pipe boolean false
24148 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24149 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24150 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24151 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24152 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24153 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24154 of them may be set.
24158 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24159 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24160 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24161 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24162 and &%return_output%& is not set,
24163 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24164 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24165 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24166 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24167 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24168 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24169 and 73, respectively.
24172 .option timeout pipe time 1h
24173 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24174 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24175 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24176 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24177 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24178 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24180 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24181 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24182 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24183 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24184 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24185 delivery to be deferred.
24187 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24188 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24191 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24192 .cindex "envelope sender"
24193 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24194 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24195 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24196 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24197 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24199 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24200 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24201 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24202 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24203 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24204 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24208 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24209 .cindex "carriage return"
24211 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24212 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24213 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24214 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24216 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24217 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24218 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24219 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24220 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24223 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
24224 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24225 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24226 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24227 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24228 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24229 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24230 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24231 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24236 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24237 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24238 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
24239 .cindex "external local delivery"
24240 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24241 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24242 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24243 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24244 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24245 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24246 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24247 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24248 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24249 configuration for &%procmail%&:
24254 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24258 check_string = "From "
24259 escape_string = ">From "
24268 transport = procmail_pipe
24270 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24271 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24272 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24273 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24274 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24275 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24277 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24281 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24282 use a shell to run pipe commands.
24285 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24286 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24289 local_delivery_cyrus:
24291 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24292 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24304 local_part_suffix = .*
24305 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24307 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24308 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24310 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
24311 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
24314 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24315 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24317 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24318 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24319 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24320 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24321 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24322 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24323 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24324 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24327 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24328 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24332 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24333 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24334 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24335 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24336 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24337 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24338 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24340 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24341 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24342 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24343 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24344 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24345 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24350 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24351 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24352 no further messages are sent over that connection.
24356 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24358 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24359 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24360 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24361 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24362 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24363 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24364 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24365 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24368 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24369 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
24370 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24371 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24372 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
24373 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24374 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24375 are the values that were set when the message was received.
24376 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24377 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24378 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24379 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24380 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24381 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24383 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24384 and will be removed in a future release.
24387 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24388 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24389 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24392 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24393 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24394 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24395 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24396 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24397 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24398 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24399 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24401 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24402 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
24403 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24404 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24405 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24406 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24407 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24408 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24409 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24412 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24414 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24415 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24416 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24417 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24418 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24421 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24422 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24423 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24424 particular connection.
24426 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24427 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24428 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24429 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24431 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24432 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24433 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24435 authenticated_sender = $local_part
24437 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24438 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24440 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24441 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24445 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24446 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24447 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24448 authenticated as a client.
24451 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24452 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24453 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24454 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24457 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24458 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24459 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24460 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24461 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24462 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24463 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24466 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24467 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24468 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24469 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24470 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24471 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24472 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24476 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24477 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24478 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24479 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24480 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24481 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24482 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24483 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24484 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24485 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24486 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24487 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24488 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24489 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24492 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24493 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24494 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24495 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24498 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24499 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24500 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24501 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24502 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24503 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24504 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24505 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24506 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24507 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24508 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24509 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24510 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24511 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24512 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24513 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24514 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24515 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24518 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24519 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24520 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
24521 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24522 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24525 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24526 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24527 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24528 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24529 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24530 unhappy at this prospect, so...
24532 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24533 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24534 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24535 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24536 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24537 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24538 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24539 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24543 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24544 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24545 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24546 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24547 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24550 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24551 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24552 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24553 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24557 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24558 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24559 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24560 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24561 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24562 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24563 the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
24564 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
24569 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24570 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24571 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24572 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24573 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24574 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24575 the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
24576 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
24577 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
24581 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24582 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24583 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24584 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24585 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24586 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24587 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24589 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24590 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24591 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24592 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24593 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24596 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24597 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24598 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24599 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24600 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24601 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24602 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24603 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24605 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24606 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24607 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24608 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24609 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24610 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24612 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24613 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24614 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24615 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24616 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24618 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24619 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24620 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24621 copy of the message is sent.
24623 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24624 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24625 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24626 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24630 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24631 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24632 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24635 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24636 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24637 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24638 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24639 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24640 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24642 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24643 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24644 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24645 implementations of TLS.
24647 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24648 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24649 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24650 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24651 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24652 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24653 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24658 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24659 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24660 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24661 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24662 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24663 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24664 interface address, you could use this:
24666 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24667 {$primary_hostname}}
24669 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24672 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24673 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24674 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24675 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24676 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24677 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24679 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24680 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24681 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24682 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24684 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24685 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24686 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24687 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24688 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24689 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24690 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24692 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24693 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24694 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24695 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24696 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24697 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24698 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24701 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24702 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24705 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24706 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24707 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24708 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24709 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24710 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24711 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24712 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24713 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24714 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24717 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24718 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24719 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24720 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24723 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
24724 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
24725 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
24726 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
24727 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
24728 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
24730 The retry hints database is used for the record,
24731 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
24732 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
24733 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
24734 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
24737 When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
24738 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
24740 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
24741 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
24742 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
24743 You have been warned.
24747 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24748 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24749 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24750 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24752 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24753 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24754 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24755 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24756 to any host that matches this list.
24759 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24760 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24761 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24762 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24763 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24764 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24765 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24766 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24769 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24770 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24771 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24776 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24777 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24778 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24779 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24780 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24781 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24782 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24783 explanation of when this might be needed.
24786 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24787 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24788 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24789 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24790 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24791 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24792 message on the same session.
24795 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24796 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24797 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24798 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24799 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24800 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24805 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24806 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24807 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24808 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24809 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24812 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24813 .cindex "randomized host list"
24814 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24815 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24816 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24817 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24818 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24819 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24820 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24821 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24823 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24824 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24825 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24826 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24828 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24830 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24831 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24832 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24834 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24835 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24836 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24837 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24838 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24839 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24840 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24841 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24842 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24845 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24846 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24847 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24848 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24849 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24851 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24852 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24853 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24854 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24855 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24856 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24857 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24858 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24859 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24861 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24862 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24863 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24864 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24865 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24867 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24868 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24869 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24870 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24871 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24872 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24874 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24875 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24876 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24877 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24878 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24879 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24880 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24882 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24883 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24884 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24885 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24886 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24887 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24888 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24890 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
24891 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24892 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24893 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24894 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24895 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24896 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24897 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24898 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24900 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
24901 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24902 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24903 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24904 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24905 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24906 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24907 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24908 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24909 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24911 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24912 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24914 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24915 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24916 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24917 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24918 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24920 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24921 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24922 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24923 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24924 for multi-recipient messages.
24925 The option can usually be left as default.
24927 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24928 .cindex "bind IP address"
24929 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24931 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24932 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24933 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24934 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24935 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24936 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24937 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24938 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24941 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24942 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24943 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24944 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24945 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24946 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
24949 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24951 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24952 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24953 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24954 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24957 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24958 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24959 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24960 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24961 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24962 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24963 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24964 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24965 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24966 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24970 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24971 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24972 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24973 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24974 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24976 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24977 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24978 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24979 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24980 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24984 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24985 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24986 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24987 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24988 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24989 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24990 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24991 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24993 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24994 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24995 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24997 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24998 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24999 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
25000 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
25001 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
25002 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
25003 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
25004 variable that contains an outgoing port.
25006 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
25007 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
25009 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
25010 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
25011 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
25014 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
25015 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
25019 .option protocol smtp string smtp
25020 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
25021 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
25022 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
25024 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
25025 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
25026 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
25027 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
25028 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
25030 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
25031 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25032 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25033 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25034 but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25035 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25038 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25039 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25040 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25041 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25042 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25043 addresses is not affected.
25045 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25046 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25047 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25048 Exim to use only the host name.
25049 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25052 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25053 .cindex "serializing connections"
25054 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25055 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25056 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25057 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25058 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25059 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25060 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25062 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25063 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25064 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25065 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25066 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25067 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25069 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25070 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25071 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25072 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25073 are used for ETRN serialization.
25075 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25078 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25079 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
25080 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25081 .cindex "size" "of message"
25082 .cindex "transport" "filter"
25083 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25084 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25085 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25086 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25087 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25088 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25089 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25091 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25092 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25095 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25096 .cindex proxy SOCKS
25097 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25098 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25101 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25102 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25103 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25105 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25106 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25107 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25108 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25109 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25112 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25113 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25114 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25115 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25119 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25120 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25121 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25122 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25123 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25126 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25127 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25128 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25129 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25130 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25131 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25134 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25137 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25138 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25140 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25141 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25142 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25143 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25144 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25145 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25146 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25147 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25150 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25151 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25152 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25154 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25155 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25156 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25157 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25158 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25159 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25160 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25161 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25162 ciphers is a preference order.
25166 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25167 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25168 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25169 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25170 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25171 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25172 certificate and private key for the session.
25174 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25176 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25182 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25183 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25184 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25185 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25186 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25187 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25188 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25189 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25190 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25191 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25195 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25196 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25197 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25198 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25199 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25200 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25201 Note that unless the host is in this list
25202 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25203 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25204 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25205 certificate verification succeeds.
25208 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25209 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25210 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25211 This option give a list of hosts for which,
25212 while verifying the server certificate,
25213 checks will be included on the host name
25214 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25215 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25216 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25218 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25221 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25222 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25223 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25225 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25226 The value of this option must be either the
25228 or the absolute path to
25229 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25230 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25232 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25233 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25234 is taken as empty and an explicit location
25237 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25238 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25240 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25242 either by file or directory
25243 are added to those given by the system default location.
25245 The values of &$host$& and
25246 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25247 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25249 For back-compatibility,
25250 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25251 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25252 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25255 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25256 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25257 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25258 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25259 certificate verification must succeed.
25260 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25261 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25262 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25264 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25265 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25266 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25267 If built with internationalization support,
25268 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25270 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25275 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25277 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25278 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25279 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25280 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25281 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25284 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25285 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25286 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25287 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25290 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25291 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25292 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25294 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25295 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25296 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25297 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25298 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25300 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25301 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25302 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25303 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25304 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25305 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25306 see below for an exception).
25308 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25309 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25310 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25311 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25312 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25314 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25315 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25316 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25317 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25318 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25319 reached their retry times.
25321 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25322 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25323 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25324 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25325 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25326 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25327 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25328 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25329 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25330 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25333 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25334 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25335 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25336 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25337 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25338 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25340 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25341 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25342 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25343 possible IP addresses have been tried.
25344 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
25345 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
25351 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25352 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25354 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25355 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25356 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25357 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25358 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25359 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25361 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25362 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25363 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25364 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25365 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25366 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25367 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25369 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25370 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25371 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25372 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25375 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25376 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25377 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25378 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25380 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25381 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25382 facility; you do not have to use it.
25384 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25385 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25386 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25387 address to which it applies.
25389 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25390 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25391 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25392 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25393 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25394 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25397 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25398 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25399 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25400 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25403 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25404 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25405 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25406 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25407 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25410 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25411 illustrated by these examples:
25414 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25415 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25416 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25417 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25419 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25420 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25425 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25426 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25427 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25428 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25429 message's processing.
25431 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25432 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25433 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25434 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25435 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25436 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25437 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25438 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25439 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25441 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25442 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25443 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25444 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25445 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25446 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25447 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25448 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25449 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25450 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25452 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25453 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25454 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25455 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25456 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25457 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25459 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25460 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25461 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25463 .cindex "envelope from"
25464 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25465 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25466 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25467 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25468 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25469 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25470 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25471 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25472 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25474 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25475 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25481 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25482 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25483 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25484 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25485 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25486 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
25487 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25488 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25489 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25490 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25492 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25494 might produce the output
25496 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25497 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25498 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25499 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25500 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25501 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25502 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25503 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25505 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25506 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25507 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25508 set for a particular transport.
25511 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25512 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25513 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25516 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25518 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25519 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25520 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25521 any colons must be doubled, of course).
25523 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25524 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25525 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25526 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25529 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25530 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25531 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25533 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25534 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25535 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25536 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25537 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25538 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25539 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25541 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25542 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25543 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25544 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25545 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25549 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25550 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25553 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25554 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25555 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25556 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25557 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25558 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25559 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25560 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25561 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25563 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25564 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25565 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25567 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25568 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25569 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25570 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25571 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25572 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25573 of pattern they are set as follows:
25576 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25577 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25578 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25581 *queen@*.fict.example
25583 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25585 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25589 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25590 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25593 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25594 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25595 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25596 rewriting rule of the form
25598 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25600 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25606 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25607 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25608 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25609 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25610 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25614 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25615 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25616 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25617 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25618 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25620 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25622 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25625 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25626 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25627 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25628 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25629 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25630 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25631 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25632 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25633 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25634 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25635 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25636 entry written to the panic log.
25640 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25641 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25644 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25647 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25649 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25652 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25653 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25657 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25659 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25660 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25661 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25662 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25663 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25664 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25666 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25667 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25668 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25669 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25670 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25671 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25672 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25673 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25674 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25675 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25677 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25678 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25679 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25681 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25682 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25685 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25686 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25687 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25688 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25689 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25690 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25691 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25692 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25693 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25695 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25696 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25697 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25698 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25699 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25700 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25701 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25702 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25705 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25706 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25707 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25708 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25711 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25712 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25713 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25715 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25716 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25717 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25718 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25720 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25721 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25722 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25724 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25725 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25726 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25727 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25729 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25733 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25736 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25737 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25738 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25739 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25740 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25741 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25742 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25743 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25745 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25746 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25750 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25751 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25753 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25754 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25755 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25757 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25758 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25759 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25760 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25761 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25762 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25763 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25764 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25766 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25767 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25769 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25771 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25772 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25774 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25775 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25776 messages that originate outside the local host:
25778 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25779 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25781 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25784 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25785 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25786 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25787 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25788 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25789 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25790 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25791 components. For example, the rule
25793 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25795 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25796 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25797 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25798 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25799 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25800 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25801 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25808 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25809 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25811 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25812 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25813 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25814 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25815 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25816 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25817 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25818 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25819 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25820 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25821 address, domain and error.
25823 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25824 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25825 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25826 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25827 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25828 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25829 log selector is set, the message
25830 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25831 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25832 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25833 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25835 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25836 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25837 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25838 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25839 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25840 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25841 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25842 domain are maintained independently.
25844 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25845 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25846 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25847 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25848 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25849 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25850 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25851 the local address is reached.
25853 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25854 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25855 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25856 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25857 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25859 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25860 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25861 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25862 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25863 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25864 messages that it should now be retaining.
25868 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25869 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25870 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25871 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25872 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25873 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25874 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25875 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25876 message's sender, respectively.
25879 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25880 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25881 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25882 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25883 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25884 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25887 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25889 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25892 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25894 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25895 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25898 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25899 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25900 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25901 expressions work in address lists.
25903 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25904 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25908 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25909 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25910 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25911 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25912 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25913 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25914 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25915 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25916 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25918 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25919 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25920 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25921 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25924 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25925 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25926 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25927 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25928 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25929 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25930 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25931 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25932 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25933 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25938 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25940 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25941 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25942 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25943 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25944 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25945 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25947 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25951 and the retry rules are
25953 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25954 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25956 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25957 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25958 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25959 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25960 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25961 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25963 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25964 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25965 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25966 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25968 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25969 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25970 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25972 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25974 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25975 textual form of the IP address.
25977 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25978 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25979 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25980 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25983 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25984 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25985 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25987 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25988 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25989 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25991 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25992 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25994 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25995 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25998 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25999 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
26000 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
26001 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
26002 retry rule of this form:
26004 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
26006 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
26007 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
26010 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
26011 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
26012 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
26013 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
26016 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
26017 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
26018 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
26019 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
26020 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
26022 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
26023 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
26025 .vitem &%refused_A%&
26026 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
26029 A connection was refused.
26031 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26032 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26034 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26035 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26037 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26038 A connection attempt timed out.
26040 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26041 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26042 obtained from an MX record.
26044 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
26045 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26046 obtained from an MX record.
26049 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26051 .vitem &%tls_required%&
26052 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26053 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26054 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26057 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26060 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26061 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26062 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26063 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26064 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26065 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26069 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26070 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26071 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26072 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26073 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26077 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26078 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26079 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26081 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26082 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26083 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26084 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26085 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26086 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26087 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26089 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26090 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26093 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26094 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26095 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26100 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26101 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26102 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26103 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26104 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26107 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26109 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26111 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26113 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26114 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26117 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26119 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26120 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26121 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26122 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26123 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26125 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26126 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
26128 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26130 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26131 list is never matched.
26137 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26138 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26139 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26140 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26142 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26144 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26145 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26146 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26147 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26148 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26150 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26151 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26152 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26153 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26154 The available algorithms are:
26157 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26160 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26161 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26162 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26164 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26165 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26166 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26167 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26168 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26169 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26170 queue processing times.
26173 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26174 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26175 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26176 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26177 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26178 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26179 interval is found. The main configuration variable
26180 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26181 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26182 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26183 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26184 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26186 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26187 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26188 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26189 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26190 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26191 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26194 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26195 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26196 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26197 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26198 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26199 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26200 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26201 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26202 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26203 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26204 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26205 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26207 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26208 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26209 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26210 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26211 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26212 deliveries that have been deferred.
26215 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26216 Here are some example retry rules:
26218 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26219 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26220 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26221 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26222 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
26223 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26225 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26226 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26227 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26228 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26229 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26230 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26231 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26234 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26235 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26236 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26237 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26238 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26240 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26241 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26242 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26243 were not obtained from an MX record.
26245 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26246 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26247 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26248 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
26249 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26253 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26254 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26255 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26256 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26257 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26258 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26259 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26260 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26261 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26262 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26263 failing for the first time.
26265 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26266 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26267 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26268 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26270 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26271 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26272 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26277 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26278 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26279 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26280 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26281 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26282 default retry rule:
26284 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26286 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26287 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26288 failure for the recipient address that counts.
26290 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26291 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26292 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26293 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26294 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26296 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26297 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26298 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26300 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26301 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
26302 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26303 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26304 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26305 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26306 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26307 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26308 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26309 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26310 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26312 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26313 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26314 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26315 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26316 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26319 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26320 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26321 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26322 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26323 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26324 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26325 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26326 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26327 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26330 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26331 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26332 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26333 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26334 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26335 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26336 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26337 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26340 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26341 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26342 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26343 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26344 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26345 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26346 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26347 time out the address.
26349 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26350 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26351 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26352 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26353 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26354 considered immediately.
26355 .ecindex IIDretconf1
26356 .ecindex IIDregconf2
26363 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26364 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26366 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26367 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26368 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26369 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26370 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26371 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26372 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26373 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26374 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26377 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26378 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26381 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26382 the client's EHLO command.
26384 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26385 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26387 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26388 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26389 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26390 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26391 with the AUTH command.
26393 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26395 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26396 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26397 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26400 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26401 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26402 unauthenticated connection.
26405 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26406 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26407 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26408 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26410 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26411 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26412 &`Connected to server.example.`&
26413 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
26414 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26415 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26416 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26417 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26422 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26423 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26424 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26425 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26426 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26427 included by setting
26430 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26434 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26439 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26440 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26441 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26442 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26443 work via a socket interface.
26445 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26446 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26448 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26449 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26450 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26451 supporting setting a server keytab.
26452 The seventh can be configured to support
26453 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26454 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26455 The eighth authenticator
26456 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26457 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26458 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26460 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26461 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26462 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26463 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26464 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26465 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26466 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26468 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26469 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26470 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26471 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26472 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26473 both sets of options, is required. For example:
26477 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26478 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26480 client_secret = secret2
26482 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26483 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26485 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26486 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26487 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26490 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26491 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26492 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26493 authenticating data.
26495 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26496 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26497 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26498 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26499 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26500 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26501 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26502 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26503 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26504 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26507 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26508 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26509 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26510 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26514 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26515 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26516 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26518 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26519 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26520 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26521 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26522 encrypted by a setting such as:
26524 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26528 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26529 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26530 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26531 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26534 .option driver authenticators string unset
26535 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26536 authenticators is to be used.
26539 .option public_name authenticators string unset
26540 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26541 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26542 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26543 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26544 defaults to the driver's instance name.
26547 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26548 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26549 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26550 mechanism is not advertised.
26551 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26552 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26553 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26556 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26557 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26558 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26561 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26562 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26564 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26565 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26566 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26567 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26568 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26569 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26570 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26571 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26572 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26576 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26577 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26578 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26579 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26580 out the values of variables.
26581 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26582 output, and Exim carries on processing.
26585 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26586 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26587 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26588 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26589 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26590 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26591 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26592 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26593 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26594 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26595 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26596 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26599 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26600 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26601 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26602 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26603 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26604 remembered for later use.
26605 How it is used is described in the following section.
26611 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26612 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26613 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26614 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26615 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26619 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26620 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26622 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26624 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26625 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26626 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26627 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26628 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26629 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26630 given for the MAIL command.
26632 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26633 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26636 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26637 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26638 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26639 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26640 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26641 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26642 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26647 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26648 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26649 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26650 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26652 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26653 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26654 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26655 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26656 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26661 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26662 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26663 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26664 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26668 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26670 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26671 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26674 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26675 the mechanisms are advertised.
26677 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26678 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26679 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26680 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26681 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26682 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26683 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26685 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26687 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26689 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26690 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26691 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26694 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26696 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26697 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26698 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26700 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26701 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26702 command. This is the case if
26705 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26707 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26709 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26710 server authenticators.
26714 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26715 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26716 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26718 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26719 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26720 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26721 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26722 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26723 rejected with a 504 error.
26725 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26726 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26727 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26728 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26729 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26730 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26731 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26732 no successful authentication.
26734 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26735 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26736 &%authresults%& expansion item.
26741 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26742 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26743 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26744 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26745 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26746 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26747 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26751 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26753 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26754 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26755 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26756 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26757 command line to run this script on such data might be
26759 encode '\0user\0password'
26761 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26762 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26763 whose code value is zero.
26765 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26766 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26767 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26768 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26770 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26771 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26772 example, a command such as
26774 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26776 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26778 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26779 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26781 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26783 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26784 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26785 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26786 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26790 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26791 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26792 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26793 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26794 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26795 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26798 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26799 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26800 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26801 of the authenticator.
26804 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26805 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26806 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26807 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26808 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26809 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26810 delivery to be deferred.
26812 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26813 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26814 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26817 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26818 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26819 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26820 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26821 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26822 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26823 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26824 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26825 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26828 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26829 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26830 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26831 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26832 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26833 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26834 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26835 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26837 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26839 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26840 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26841 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26842 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26843 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26844 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26845 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26846 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26847 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26848 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26849 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26850 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26851 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26858 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26861 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26862 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26863 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26864 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26865 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26866 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26867 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26868 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26869 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26870 connections as you do for login accounts.
26872 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26873 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26874 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26876 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26877 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26878 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26880 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26881 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26882 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26885 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26886 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26887 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26888 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26889 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26890 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26891 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26893 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26894 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26895 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26896 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26897 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26898 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26899 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26901 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26902 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26903 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26904 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26906 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26907 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26908 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26910 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26911 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26912 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26913 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26914 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26915 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26916 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26917 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26918 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26919 string as the error text.
26921 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26922 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26923 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26927 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26928 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26929 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26930 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26931 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26932 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26933 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26934 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26936 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26937 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26938 configured as follows:
26942 public_name = PLAIN
26944 server_condition = \
26945 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26946 server_set_id = $auth2
26948 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26949 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26950 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26951 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26953 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26954 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26955 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26956 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26960 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26962 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26964 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26965 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26969 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26970 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26972 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26973 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26974 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26975 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26976 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26978 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26979 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26980 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26982 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26983 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26984 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26985 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26986 This is an incorrect example:
26988 server_condition = \
26989 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26991 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26992 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26993 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26994 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26995 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26996 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26997 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26999 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
27000 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
27002 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
27003 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
27004 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
27005 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
27006 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
27009 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
27010 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
27011 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
27012 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
27013 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
27014 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
27015 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
27019 public_name = LOGIN
27020 server_prompts = User Name : Password
27021 server_condition = \
27022 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
27023 server_set_id = $auth1
27025 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
27026 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
27027 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
27028 strings are used to obtain two data items.
27030 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
27031 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27032 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27033 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27034 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27038 public_name = LOGIN
27039 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27040 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27043 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27044 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27045 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27046 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27048 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27049 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27050 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27051 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27052 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27053 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27054 uninterpreted string.
27057 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27058 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27059 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27060 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27061 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27067 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27068 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27069 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27071 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27072 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27073 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27074 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27077 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27078 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27079 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27080 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27081 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27082 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27083 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27084 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27085 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27086 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27087 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27088 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27090 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27091 splitting takes priority and happens first.
27093 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27094 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27095 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27096 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27099 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27100 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27104 public_name = PLAIN
27105 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27107 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27108 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
27109 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27113 public_name = LOGIN
27114 client_send = : username : mysecret
27116 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27117 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27119 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27120 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27125 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27126 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27128 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27129 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27130 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27131 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27132 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
27133 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27134 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27135 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27136 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27137 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27138 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27139 available in plain text at either end.
27142 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27143 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27144 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27145 authenticator as a server:
27147 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27148 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27149 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27150 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27151 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27152 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27153 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27154 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27155 returned to the client.
27157 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27158 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27159 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27160 numeric variables for other things.
27162 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27163 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27164 user name, authentication fails.
27168 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27169 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27170 server_set_id = $auth1
27172 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27173 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27174 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27175 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27179 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27180 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27182 server_set_id = $auth1
27184 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27185 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27187 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27188 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27189 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27194 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27195 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27196 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27197 server_set_id = $auth1
27200 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27201 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27202 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27206 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27207 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27208 computing the response to the server's challenge.
27211 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27212 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27213 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27217 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27218 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27219 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27220 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27221 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27222 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27223 send the message to the current server.
27225 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27230 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27232 client_secret = secret
27234 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
27235 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
27239 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27240 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27242 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27243 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27244 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27245 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27247 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27248 at A L Digital Ltd.
27250 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27251 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27252 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27253 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27254 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27256 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27257 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27258 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27259 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27261 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27262 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27263 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27264 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27265 depending on the driver you are using.
27267 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27268 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27269 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27270 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27271 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27274 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27275 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27276 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27277 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27278 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27279 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27280 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27281 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27284 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27285 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27286 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27287 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27288 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27289 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27293 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27294 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27295 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27296 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27299 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27300 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27301 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27302 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27306 driver = cyrus_sasl
27307 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27308 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27309 server_set_id = $auth1
27312 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27313 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27316 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27317 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27320 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27321 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27322 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27323 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27326 driver = cyrus_sasl
27327 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27328 server_set_id = $auth1
27331 driver = cyrus_sasl
27332 public_name = PLAIN
27333 server_set_id = $auth2
27335 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27336 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27337 but it is present in many binary distributions.
27338 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27339 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27344 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27345 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27346 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27347 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27348 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27349 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27350 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27351 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27352 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27353 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27354 authenticator only. There is only one option:
27356 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
27358 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27359 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27360 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27361 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27365 public_name = PLAIN
27366 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27367 server_set_id = $auth1
27372 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27373 server_set_id = $auth1
27375 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27376 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27377 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27378 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27379 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27380 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27381 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27382 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27385 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27386 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27387 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27388 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27389 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27390 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27391 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27392 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27393 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27394 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27395 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27396 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27397 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27398 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
27399 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
27400 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27401 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27402 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27403 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27404 without code changes in Exim.
27406 Exim's &(gsasl)& authenticator does not have client-side support at this
27407 time; only the server-side support is implemented. Patches welcome.
27410 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27411 Do not set this true without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27413 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27414 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27415 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27416 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27419 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27420 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27421 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27423 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
27424 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27425 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27427 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27428 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27429 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27431 However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be broken in current versions.
27432 Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27433 with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27436 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27437 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27438 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27439 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27442 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27443 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27444 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27445 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27450 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27451 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27452 server_set_id = $auth1
27456 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27457 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27458 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27459 the password itself.
27461 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27462 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27463 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27464 if available, else the empty string.
27465 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27466 else the empty string.
27468 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27470 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27471 option to be simply "true".
27474 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27475 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27476 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27479 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
27480 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27481 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27482 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27485 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27486 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27487 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27488 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27491 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27492 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27493 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27496 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27497 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27498 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27499 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27501 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27502 meanings for these variables:
27505 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27506 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27508 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27509 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27511 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
27512 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27515 On a per-mechanism basis:
27518 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27519 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27520 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27522 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27523 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27524 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27526 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27527 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27528 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27529 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27532 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27533 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27534 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27537 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27538 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27540 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27542 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27543 server_realm = imap.example.org
27544 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27545 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27546 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27547 server_condition = yes
27551 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27552 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27554 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27555 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27556 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27557 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27558 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27559 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27560 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27563 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27564 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27565 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27566 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27568 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27569 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27570 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27571 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27573 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27574 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27575 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27579 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27580 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27581 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27582 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27584 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27585 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27586 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27587 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27589 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27591 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27592 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27594 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27595 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27596 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27601 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27602 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27604 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27605 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27606 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27607 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27608 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27609 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27610 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
27611 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27612 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27613 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27614 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27615 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27616 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27620 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27621 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27623 The server sends back a challenge.
27625 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27626 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27629 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27633 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27634 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27635 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27637 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27638 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27639 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27640 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27641 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27642 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27643 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27644 for other things. For example:
27649 server_password = \
27650 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27652 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27653 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27659 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27660 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27661 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27665 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27666 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27669 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27670 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27673 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27674 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27675 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27681 client_username = msn/msn_username
27682 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27683 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27685 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27686 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27692 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27693 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27695 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
27696 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
27697 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
27698 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27699 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27700 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27701 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
27702 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
27703 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
27704 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
27705 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
27706 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
27707 by the server configuration.
27709 The client presents an identity in-clear.
27710 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
27711 and for clients to only attempt,
27712 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
27714 One possible use, compatible with the
27715 K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
27716 is for using X509 client certificates.
27718 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
27719 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
27720 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
27721 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
27722 client certificates only.
27724 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
27725 client-certificate authentication is being done.
27727 The client must present a certificate,
27728 for which it must have been requested via the
27729 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27730 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27731 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
27732 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
27734 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
27735 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
27736 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
27738 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
27739 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
27740 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27741 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
27742 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
27743 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27744 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27746 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
27748 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
27749 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27750 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27751 "in &(external)& authenticator"
27752 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27753 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27755 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
27756 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27757 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27758 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
27759 an identity for authentication and
27760 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
27762 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
27763 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
27764 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27765 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27767 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27768 Once an identity has been received,
27769 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27770 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27771 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27772 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27773 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27774 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27775 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27776 string as the error text.
27780 ext_ccert_san_mail:
27782 public_name = EXTERNAL
27784 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
27785 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27786 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27787 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
27788 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
27789 server_set_id = $auth1
27791 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27792 of your configured trust-anchors
27793 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27794 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
27796 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27797 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27798 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27800 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27803 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
27804 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
27805 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
27807 .option client_send external string&!! unset
27808 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
27809 identity being asserted.
27815 public_name = EXTERNAL
27817 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27818 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
27822 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
27823 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
27829 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27830 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27832 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27833 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27834 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27835 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27836 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27837 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27838 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27839 authentication based on client certificates.
27841 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27842 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27843 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27844 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27845 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27846 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27848 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27849 for which it must have been requested via the
27850 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27851 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27853 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27854 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27855 and can authenticate the connection.
27856 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27858 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27861 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27862 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27864 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27865 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27866 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27867 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27868 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27869 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27871 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27872 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27873 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27875 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27882 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27883 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27884 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
27887 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27888 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27889 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27891 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27893 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27894 of your configured trust-anchors
27895 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27896 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27898 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27899 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27900 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27902 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27904 . An alternative might use
27906 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27908 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27909 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27910 . This would help for per-device use.
27912 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27913 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27915 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27916 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27919 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27920 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27921 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27925 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27926 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27928 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27929 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27930 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27931 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27932 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27935 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27936 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27937 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27938 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27939 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27940 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27941 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27942 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27943 certificates are used.
27945 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27946 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27947 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27948 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27949 between them is encrypted.
27951 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27952 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27953 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27954 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27957 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27958 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27959 in order to get TLS to work.
27963 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27965 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27966 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27967 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27968 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27969 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27970 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27971 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27972 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27973 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27974 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27975 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
27977 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27978 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27979 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27981 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27982 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27983 reassigned for other use.
27984 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27986 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
27987 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27988 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27990 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27991 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27992 the most common use is expected to be:
27994 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27996 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27997 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27998 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27999 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
28000 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
28003 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
28004 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
28011 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
28012 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
28013 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
28014 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
28015 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
28019 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
28023 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
28024 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
28026 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
28029 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
28030 cannot be the path of a directory
28031 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
28032 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
28034 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
28036 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28037 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
28038 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
28039 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
28040 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
28042 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
28043 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
28044 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
28045 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
28046 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
28047 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
28048 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
28051 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
28052 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
28054 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
28055 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
28056 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
28057 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
28059 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
28060 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
28062 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
28063 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
28064 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
28065 implementation, then patches are welcome.
28069 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
28070 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
28071 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
28072 but not the chosen filename.
28073 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
28074 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
28076 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
28077 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
28078 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
28079 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
28081 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
28082 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
28083 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
28084 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
28085 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
28086 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
28087 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
28089 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
28090 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
28091 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
28092 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
28093 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
28095 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28096 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28097 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28098 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28099 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28100 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28102 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28103 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28104 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28106 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28107 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28108 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28109 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28112 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28115 # chown exim:exim new-params
28116 # chmod 0600 new-params
28117 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28118 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28119 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28120 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28121 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28122 # chmod 0400 new-params
28123 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28125 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28126 stalling is removed.
28128 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28129 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28130 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28131 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28132 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28133 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28134 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28135 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28136 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28137 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28138 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28140 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28141 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28142 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
28143 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28145 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28146 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28147 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28148 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28149 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28152 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28153 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28154 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28155 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28156 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28157 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28158 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28159 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28160 directly to this function call.
28161 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28162 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28163 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28164 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28167 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28169 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28170 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28171 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28174 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28175 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28176 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28180 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28183 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28184 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28187 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28188 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28190 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28191 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28194 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28195 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28196 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28197 not be moved to the end of the list.
28200 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28203 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28204 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28207 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28208 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28209 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28210 choice of clients used:
28212 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28213 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28218 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28220 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28223 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28224 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28225 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28226 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28228 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28230 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28234 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28236 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28237 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28238 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28239 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28240 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28241 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28242 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28243 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28244 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28245 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28247 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28248 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28250 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28251 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28252 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28253 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28254 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28255 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28257 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28258 "Priority strings". This is online as
28259 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28260 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28261 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28262 then the example code
28263 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28264 on that site can be used to test a given string.
28268 # Disable older versions of protocols
28269 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28272 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28273 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28274 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28276 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28277 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28278 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28279 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28283 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28289 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28290 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28291 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28292 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28293 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28294 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28295 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28297 If STARTTLS is to be used you
28298 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28300 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28301 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28302 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28305 554 Security failure
28307 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28308 rejected with a 554 error code.
28310 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28311 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28313 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28314 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28315 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28316 from someone able to intercept the communication.
28318 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28320 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28322 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28323 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28325 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28326 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28327 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28328 that goes with it. These files need to be
28329 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28330 always be given as full path names.
28331 The key must not be password-protected.
28332 They can be the same file if both the
28333 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28334 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28335 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28336 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28337 the server's certificate.
28339 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28340 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28341 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28342 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28343 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28344 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28346 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28347 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28348 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28350 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28351 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28352 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28355 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28356 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28357 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28359 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28361 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28362 with the parameters contained in the file.
28363 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28368 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28369 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28370 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28371 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28377 for a way of generating file data.
28379 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28380 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28381 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28382 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28383 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28385 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28386 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28387 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28388 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28389 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28390 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28391 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28392 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28393 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28395 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28396 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28397 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28398 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28399 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28400 documentation for more details.
28402 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28403 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28406 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28407 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28408 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28409 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28410 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28411 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28412 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28413 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28414 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28415 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28416 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28417 an explicit file or,
28418 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28419 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28421 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28424 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28425 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28426 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28428 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28430 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28432 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28433 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28435 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28436 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28437 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28438 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28439 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28440 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28441 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28442 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28443 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28444 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28446 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28447 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28448 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28449 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28451 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28452 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28453 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28454 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28455 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28456 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28459 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28460 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28461 .cindex "revocation list"
28462 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28463 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28464 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28465 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28466 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28467 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28468 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28470 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28471 file from every certificate authority they know of.
28473 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28474 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28475 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28476 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28477 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28478 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28480 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28481 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28482 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28483 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28485 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28486 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28487 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28488 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28489 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28490 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28491 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28492 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28494 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28495 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28496 support for OCSP stapling is included.
28498 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28499 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28500 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28501 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28502 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28504 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28505 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28506 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28507 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28508 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28511 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28512 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28515 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28516 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28517 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28518 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28519 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28520 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28522 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28523 not any of the chain from CA to it.
28525 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28528 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28529 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28530 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28532 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28533 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28534 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28540 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
28541 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28542 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28543 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28544 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28545 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28546 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28547 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28548 within the &(smtp)& transport.
28550 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28551 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28552 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28553 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28554 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28556 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28557 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28558 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28559 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28560 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28563 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28564 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28565 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28566 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28567 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28568 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28569 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28570 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28571 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28572 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28575 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28576 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28577 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28578 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28581 Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
28582 for client use (they are usable for server use).
28583 As TLS has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
28584 in failed connections.
28587 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28588 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28590 the system default set (depending on library version),
28592 or (depending on library version) a directory.
28593 The client verifies the server's certificate
28594 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28595 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28596 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28597 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28599 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28600 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28601 or need not succeed respectively.
28603 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28604 checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28605 is valid for the certificate.
28606 The option defaults to always checking.
28608 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28609 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28610 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28612 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28613 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28614 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28617 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28618 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28619 for OCSP to be relevant.
28622 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28623 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28624 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28625 alternative hosts, if any.
28628 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28629 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28630 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28634 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28635 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28636 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28637 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28638 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28640 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28641 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28642 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28643 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28644 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28645 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28646 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28647 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28648 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28649 outgoing connection.
28653 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28654 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28655 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28656 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28657 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28658 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28659 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28660 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28661 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28662 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28665 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28666 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28669 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28670 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28671 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28672 be of limited use in that environment.
28674 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28675 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28676 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28677 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28678 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28680 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28681 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28682 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28683 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28684 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28686 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28687 received from a client.
28688 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28690 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28691 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28692 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28695 &%tls_certificate%&
28701 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
28706 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28707 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28708 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28709 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28710 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
28711 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28712 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28714 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28717 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28718 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28719 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28720 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28722 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
28723 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28724 built, then you have SNI support).
28728 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28730 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28731 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28732 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28733 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28734 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28735 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28736 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28737 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28738 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28739 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28741 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28742 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28743 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28744 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28745 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28746 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28747 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28749 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28750 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28751 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28752 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28753 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28754 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28755 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28756 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28757 and delay other deliveries to that host.
28759 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28760 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28761 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28762 information is recorded.
28764 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28765 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28766 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28771 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28772 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28773 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28774 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28775 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28776 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28778 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28779 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28780 document is currently at
28782 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28784 and their FAQ is at
28786 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28789 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
28790 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28792 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28793 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28794 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28795 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28798 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28799 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28800 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28801 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28802 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28803 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28804 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28805 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28806 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28807 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28808 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28809 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28810 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28812 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28813 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28814 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28815 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28819 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28820 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28821 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28822 with OpenSSL, like this:
28823 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28824 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28826 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28829 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28830 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28831 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28832 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28833 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28834 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28835 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28837 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28838 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28839 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28840 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28841 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28842 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28844 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28845 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28846 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28847 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28848 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28849 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28850 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28851 be a sensible resolution).
28853 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28854 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28855 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28857 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28858 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28859 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28860 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28861 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28862 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28864 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28865 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28866 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28867 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28868 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28869 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28873 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28875 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28876 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28877 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28878 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28879 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28880 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28882 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28883 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28884 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28886 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28887 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28889 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28890 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28891 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28893 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28894 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28895 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28897 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28898 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28900 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28901 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28902 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28903 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28905 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
28906 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
28907 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
28908 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
28910 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
28911 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
28912 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
28913 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
28914 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28915 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28917 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
28918 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
28919 does require careful arrangement.
28920 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
28921 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
28922 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28923 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28924 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
28926 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
28927 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
28929 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
28930 "MTA-STS", described below.
28932 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
28933 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
28934 connections to you.
28935 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
28936 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
28937 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
28938 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
28939 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
28940 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
28942 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
28943 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
28944 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
28945 random serial numbers.
28946 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
28947 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
28948 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
28949 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
28951 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
28952 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
28954 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
28957 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28958 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28963 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
28965 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
28968 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
28971 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28972 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
28975 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28977 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
28978 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
28979 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
28980 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
28982 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
28983 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
28985 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28986 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28987 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28990 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28991 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28995 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28996 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28997 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28998 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28999 control the OCSP request.
29001 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
29002 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
29005 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
29006 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
29007 The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not
29008 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
29009 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
29011 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
29013 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
29014 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
29015 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
29016 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
29018 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
29019 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
29020 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
29021 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
29022 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
29023 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
29024 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
29026 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
29030 tls_try_verify_hosts
29031 tls_verify_certificates
29033 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
29036 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
29037 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
29039 Currently the (router or transport options) &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
29041 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
29043 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
29044 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
29045 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
29046 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
29048 .cindex DANE reporting
29049 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
29050 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
29051 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
29052 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
29053 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
29054 Section 4.3 of that document.
29056 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
29058 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
29059 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
29060 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
29061 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
29062 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
29063 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
29064 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
29065 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
29068 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
29069 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
29070 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
29072 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
29073 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
29074 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
29075 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
29076 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
29077 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
29078 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
29082 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29083 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29085 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
29086 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
29087 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
29088 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
29089 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
29090 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
29091 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
29092 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
29093 one very small ACL:
29097 accept hosts = one.host.only
29099 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
29100 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
29102 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
29103 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
29104 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
29105 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
29106 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
29107 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
29108 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
29109 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29112 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
29113 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
29114 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29117 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29118 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29119 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29120 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29121 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29122 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29123 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29124 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29125 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29126 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29127 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29128 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29129 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29130 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29131 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29132 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29133 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29134 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29135 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29136 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29139 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29140 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29141 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29142 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29143 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29144 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29145 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29146 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29147 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29148 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29149 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29150 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29151 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29152 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29153 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29154 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29155 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29156 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29157 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29158 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29161 For example, if you set
29163 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29165 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29166 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29167 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29168 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29169 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29170 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29171 testing as possible at RCPT time.
29174 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29175 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29176 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29177 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29178 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29179 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29180 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29181 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29182 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29183 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29184 in any of these ACLs.
29186 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29187 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29188 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29189 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29190 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29191 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29192 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29193 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29195 control = suppress_local_fixups
29197 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29198 run, it is too late.
29200 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29201 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29203 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29204 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29205 temporary error for these kinds of message.
29208 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29209 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29210 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29211 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29212 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29213 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29214 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29215 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29216 &%smtp_banner%& option.
29219 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29220 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29221 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29222 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29223 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29224 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29225 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29226 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29227 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29229 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29230 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29231 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29233 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29234 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29235 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29236 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29240 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29241 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29242 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29243 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29244 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29245 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29246 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29247 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29248 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29249 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29251 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29252 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29253 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29254 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29255 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29256 associated with the DATA command.
29258 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29259 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29260 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29261 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29262 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29263 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29264 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29265 the data specified is received.
29267 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29268 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29269 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29270 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29271 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29274 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29275 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29276 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29277 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29279 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29280 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29281 enabled (which is the default).
29283 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29284 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29285 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29287 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29289 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29292 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29293 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29294 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29296 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29299 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29300 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29301 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29302 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29303 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29304 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29305 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29308 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29309 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29310 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29311 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29312 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29313 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29314 for some or all recipients.
29316 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29317 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29318 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29319 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29320 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29322 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29323 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29324 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29326 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29327 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29329 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29330 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29331 the feature was not requested by the client.
29333 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29334 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29335 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29336 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29337 does not in fact control any access.
29338 For this reason, it may only accept
29339 or warn as its final result.
29341 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29342 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29343 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29344 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29346 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29347 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29349 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29350 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29353 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29354 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29355 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29356 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29357 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29360 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29361 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29362 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29363 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29364 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29365 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29366 situation even worse.
29368 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29369 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29370 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29373 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29374 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29375 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29376 connection. The possible values are:
29378 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29379 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29380 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29381 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29382 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29383 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29384 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29385 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29386 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29387 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29389 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29390 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29391 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29392 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29393 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29397 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29398 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29399 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29400 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29402 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29403 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29405 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29406 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29407 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29408 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29409 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29411 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29412 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29413 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29416 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29417 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29418 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29419 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29420 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29421 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29423 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29424 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29425 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29427 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29428 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29429 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29430 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29432 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29433 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29434 matches the string.
29436 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29437 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29438 want to have something like
29440 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29442 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29443 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29449 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29450 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29451 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29452 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29453 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29454 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29455 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29456 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29457 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29459 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29460 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29461 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29464 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29465 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29466 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29467 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29469 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29470 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29471 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29472 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29473 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29474 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29475 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29477 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29478 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29481 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29482 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29483 recipients; it may create new recipients.
29487 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29488 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29489 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29490 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29491 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29492 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29494 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29495 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29496 used to accept or reject anything.
29498 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29499 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29500 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29501 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29503 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29504 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29505 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29506 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29507 configuration file.
29512 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29513 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29515 .vindex &$local_part$&
29516 .vindex &$sender_address$&
29517 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29518 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29519 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29520 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29521 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29522 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29523 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29524 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29526 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29527 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29528 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29531 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
29532 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29533 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29534 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29535 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29538 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29539 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29540 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29541 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29542 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29543 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29544 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29545 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29551 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29552 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29553 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29554 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29555 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29556 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29557 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29558 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29559 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29560 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29561 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29562 unencrypted connections.
29565 accept encrypted = *
29566 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29568 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29570 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29571 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29572 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29573 option to do this.)
29577 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29578 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29579 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29580 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29581 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29582 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29583 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29585 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29586 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29587 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29590 deny dnslists = list1.example
29591 dnslists = list2.example
29593 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29594 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29595 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29596 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29597 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29600 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29601 The ACL verbs are as follows:
29604 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29605 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29606 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29607 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29608 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29609 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29610 check a RCPT command:
29612 accept domains = +local_domains
29616 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29617 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29618 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29619 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29622 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29623 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29624 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29627 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29628 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29629 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29630 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29631 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29632 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29634 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29635 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29637 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29638 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29639 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29641 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29642 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29643 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29648 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29649 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29650 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29651 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29652 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29653 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29654 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29658 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29659 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29660 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29663 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29665 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29669 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29670 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29671 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29672 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29673 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29674 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29675 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29676 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29677 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29679 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29680 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29681 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29685 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29686 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29687 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29689 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29690 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29692 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29693 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29696 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29697 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29698 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29699 example, when checking a RCPT command,
29701 require message = Sender did not verify
29704 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29705 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29706 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29707 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29710 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29711 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29712 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29713 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29714 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29715 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29716 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29718 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29719 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29720 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29721 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29722 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29724 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29725 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29726 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29727 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29728 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29729 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29733 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29734 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29735 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29736 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29738 warn !verify = sender
29739 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29743 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29745 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29746 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29747 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29748 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29749 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29753 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29754 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29755 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29756 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29757 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29758 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29759 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29760 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29761 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29762 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29764 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29765 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29766 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29767 on the same SMTP connection.
29769 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29770 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29771 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29774 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29775 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29776 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29778 accept hosts = whatever
29779 set acl_m4 = some value
29780 accept authenticated = *
29781 set acl_c_auth = yes
29783 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29784 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29785 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29787 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29788 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29789 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29790 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29791 error is generated.
29793 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29794 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29797 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29798 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29799 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29800 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29802 deny domains = *.dom.example
29803 !verify = recipient
29805 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29806 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29807 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29808 two statements are equivalent:
29810 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29811 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29813 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29814 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29816 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29817 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29818 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29820 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29821 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29822 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29823 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29825 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29826 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29827 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29828 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29829 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29830 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29831 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29833 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29834 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29835 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29836 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29837 message is handled.
29839 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29840 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29841 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29842 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29844 require message = Can't verify sender
29846 message = Can't verify recipient
29848 message = This message cannot be used
29850 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29851 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29852 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29853 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29854 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29855 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29857 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29858 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29859 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29860 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29863 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29864 message = Invalid sender from client host
29866 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29867 by which time Exim has set up the message.
29871 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29872 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29873 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29876 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29877 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29878 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29879 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29881 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29882 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29883 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29884 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29885 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29886 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29887 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29888 write rather ugly lines like this:
29890 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29892 Instead, all you need is
29894 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29897 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29898 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29899 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29900 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29901 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29902 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29903 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29904 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29906 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29907 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29908 in several different ways. For example:
29910 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29911 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29912 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29916 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29918 accept ...some conditions
29919 control = queue_only
29921 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29922 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29925 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29927 accept ...some conditions...
29928 control = queue_only
29929 ...some more conditions...
29931 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29932 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29933 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29937 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29938 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29941 warn ...some conditions...
29945 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29946 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29950 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29951 &%require%& verb. For example:
29953 require control = no_multiline_responses
29957 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29958 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29960 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29961 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29962 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29963 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29964 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29965 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29967 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29970 deny ...some conditions...
29973 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29974 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
29977 ...some conditions...
29979 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29980 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29982 warn ...some conditions...
29988 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29989 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29990 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29991 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29992 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29993 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29994 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29998 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29999 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
30000 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
30001 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
30002 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
30003 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
30004 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
30007 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30008 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
30009 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
30010 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
30012 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
30013 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
30015 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
30018 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
30019 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
30021 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
30022 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
30023 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
30026 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
30027 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
30028 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
30029 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
30030 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
30031 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
30034 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30035 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
30036 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
30039 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
30040 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
30041 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
30042 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
30043 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
30044 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
30046 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
30047 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
30048 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
30049 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
30050 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
30051 logging rejections.
30054 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
30055 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
30056 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
30057 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
30058 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
30059 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
30060 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
30061 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
30063 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
30064 &` log_reject_target =`&
30066 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
30067 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
30071 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30072 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
30073 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
30074 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
30075 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
30076 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
30077 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
30080 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
30081 &` control = freeze`&
30082 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
30084 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
30085 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
30086 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
30089 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
30090 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
30094 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30095 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
30096 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
30097 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
30098 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
30099 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
30100 &%accept%& for details.)
30102 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
30103 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
30104 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
30105 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
30106 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
30108 require message = Host not recognized
30111 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
30114 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
30115 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30116 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30117 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30118 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30119 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30120 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30121 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30122 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30125 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30126 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30127 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30129 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30130 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30132 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30133 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30134 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
30137 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30138 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30140 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30141 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30142 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30145 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30146 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30147 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30149 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30150 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30151 However, the original message is available in the variable
30152 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30153 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30154 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30155 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30157 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30158 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30159 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30160 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30161 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30162 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30166 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30167 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30168 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30169 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30171 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30173 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30174 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30175 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30176 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30179 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30180 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30181 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30182 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30185 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30186 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30187 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30188 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30191 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30192 .cindex "UDP communications"
30193 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30194 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30195 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30196 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30197 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30198 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30199 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30202 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30203 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30210 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30211 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30212 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30215 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30216 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30217 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30218 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30219 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30220 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30221 not work without it. For example:
30223 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30224 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30226 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30227 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30228 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30229 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30230 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30233 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30234 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30235 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30236 .cindex "case of local parts"
30237 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30238 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30239 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30240 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30241 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30242 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30245 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30246 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30247 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30248 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30249 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30251 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30252 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30255 warn control = caseful_local_part
30256 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30258 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30260 control = caselower_local_part
30262 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30263 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30266 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30267 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30268 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30269 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30271 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30272 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30273 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30274 is used for all recipients of the message,
30275 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30276 and data is copied from one to the other.
30278 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30279 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30280 If a recipient-verify callout
30282 connection is subsequently
30283 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30284 any subsequent recipients and the data,
30285 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30287 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30288 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30289 Note also that headers cannot be
30290 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30291 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30292 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30293 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30294 this will affect the timestamp.
30296 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30297 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30298 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30299 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30302 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30303 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30304 before the entire message has been received from the source.
30305 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30309 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30310 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30311 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30312 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30313 before the acceptance "<=" line.
30315 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30317 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30318 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30319 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30320 and does not queue the message.
30321 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30323 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30325 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30328 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30329 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30330 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30331 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30332 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30333 by default called &'debuglog'&.
30334 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30335 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30336 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30338 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30339 with the &'kill'& option.
30340 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30344 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30345 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30346 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30347 control = debug/kill
30351 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30352 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30353 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30354 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30355 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30358 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30359 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30360 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30361 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30362 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30363 strings or to numeric value.
30364 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30365 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30366 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30368 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30369 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30370 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30371 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30372 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30375 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30376 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30377 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30378 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30379 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30380 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30381 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30382 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30384 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30385 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30386 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30387 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30388 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30389 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30393 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30394 .cindex "fake defer"
30395 .cindex "defer, fake"
30396 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30397 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30398 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30399 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30400 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30402 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30403 .cindex "fake rejection"
30404 .cindex "rejection, fake"
30405 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30406 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30407 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30408 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30409 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30410 the same SMTP connection.
30412 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30413 message is supplied, the following is used:
30415 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30416 550-kept for evaluation.
30417 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30418 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30420 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30422 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30423 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30424 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30425 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30426 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30427 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30430 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30431 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30432 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30433 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30435 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30436 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30437 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30438 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30439 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30440 disables such output flushing.
30442 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30443 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30444 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30445 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30446 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30447 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30449 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30450 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30451 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30452 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30453 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30454 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30455 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30456 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30457 to be useful in production.
30459 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30460 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30461 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30462 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30463 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30465 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30466 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30467 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30468 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30469 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30470 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30473 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30474 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30475 verification failed"&) is sent.
30477 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30481 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30482 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30484 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30485 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30486 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30487 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30488 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30489 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30490 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30492 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30493 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30494 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30495 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30496 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30497 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30498 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30499 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
30500 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
30501 same SMTP connection.
30503 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30504 .cindex "message" "submission"
30505 .cindex "submission mode"
30506 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30507 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30508 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30509 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30510 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30511 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30512 late (the message has already been created).
30514 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30515 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30516 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30517 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30518 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30520 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30521 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30522 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30523 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30524 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30527 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30528 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30530 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30532 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30535 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30536 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30537 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30538 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30541 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30542 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30544 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30545 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30547 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30551 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30552 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30555 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30557 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30558 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30560 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30562 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30567 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30568 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30569 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30570 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30571 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30572 to an incoming message, as in this example:
30574 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30575 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30576 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30578 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30579 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30580 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30581 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30582 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30585 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30586 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30588 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30589 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30590 contains one or more newlines that
30591 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30592 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30593 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30595 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30596 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30597 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30598 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30599 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30600 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30601 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30602 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30603 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30604 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30605 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30607 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30608 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30610 until they are added to the
30611 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30612 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30613 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30614 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30615 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30616 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30617 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30619 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30621 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30622 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30624 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30625 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30627 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30628 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30630 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30631 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30632 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30633 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30636 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30637 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30638 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30639 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30640 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30641 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30642 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30645 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30646 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30647 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30648 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30649 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30651 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30652 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30653 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30654 to be a header name first.) For example:
30656 warn add_header = \
30657 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30659 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30660 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30661 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30662 up in reverse order.
30664 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30665 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30666 system filter or in a router or transport.
30670 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30671 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30672 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30673 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30674 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30675 from an incoming message, as in this example:
30677 warn message = Remove internal headers
30678 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30680 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30681 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30682 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30683 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30684 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30685 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30687 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30688 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30690 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30691 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30692 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30693 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30694 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30696 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30697 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30698 warn message = Remove internal headers
30699 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30701 Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30702 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30703 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30704 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30705 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30706 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30707 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30708 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30709 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30710 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30711 would have been removed.
30713 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30714 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30715 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30716 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30717 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30718 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30719 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30720 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30721 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30723 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30724 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30726 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30727 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30729 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30730 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30732 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30733 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30734 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30735 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30738 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30739 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30740 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30745 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30746 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30747 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30748 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30749 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30750 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30752 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30753 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30754 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30755 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30756 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30757 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30758 The conditions are as follows:
30762 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30763 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30764 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30765 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30766 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30767 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30768 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30769 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30770 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30771 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30772 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30773 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30775 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30776 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30777 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30778 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30779 The name and values are expanded separately.
30780 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30781 will act as argument separators.
30783 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30784 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30785 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30786 conditions are tested.
30788 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30789 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30790 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30791 for different local users or different local domains.
30793 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30794 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30795 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30796 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30797 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30798 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30799 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30804 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30805 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30806 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30807 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30808 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30809 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30810 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30811 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30812 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30813 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30814 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30815 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30818 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30819 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30820 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30821 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30822 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30823 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30824 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30825 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30827 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30828 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30829 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30830 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30831 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30832 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30833 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30834 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30835 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30836 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30838 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30839 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30840 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30841 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30842 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30843 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30844 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30845 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30846 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30849 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30850 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30853 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30854 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30855 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30856 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30857 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30858 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30859 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30865 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30866 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30867 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30868 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30869 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30870 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30871 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30873 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30875 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30876 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30877 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30879 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30880 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30881 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30882 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30883 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30884 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30886 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30887 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30889 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30890 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30892 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30893 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30894 statement can then check the IP address.
30896 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
30897 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30898 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30899 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30901 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30902 message = $host_data
30904 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30906 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30907 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30908 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30909 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30910 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30911 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30912 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30913 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30914 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30915 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30917 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30918 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30919 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30920 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30921 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30922 content-scanning extension
30923 and only after a DATA command.
30924 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30925 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30927 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30928 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30929 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30930 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30931 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30932 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30933 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30936 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30937 .cindex "rate limiting"
30938 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30939 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30941 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30942 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30943 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30944 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30945 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30946 recipient address against a list of recipients.
30948 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30949 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30950 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30951 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30952 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30953 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30954 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30956 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30957 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30958 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30959 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30960 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30961 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30962 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30963 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30964 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30965 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30966 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30967 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30968 influence the sender checking.
30970 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30971 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30973 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30974 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30975 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30976 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30977 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30978 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30982 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30983 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30985 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30986 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30987 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30988 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30989 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30990 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30992 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30993 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30994 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30995 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30996 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30997 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30998 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30999 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
31000 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
31001 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
31003 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
31004 .cindex "CSA verification"
31005 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
31006 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
31007 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
31009 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
31010 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31011 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31012 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31013 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
31014 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31015 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31016 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
31017 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
31018 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
31020 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
31021 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
31022 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
31024 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
31025 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31026 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
31027 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
31028 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
31029 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
31030 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31031 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31032 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
31033 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
31034 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
31035 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
31036 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
31037 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
31038 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
31040 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
31041 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
31042 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
31043 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
31046 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
31047 !verify = header_sender
31050 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
31051 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31052 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
31053 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
31054 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
31055 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31056 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31057 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
31058 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
31059 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
31060 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
31061 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
31062 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
31065 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
31066 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
31070 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
31071 common as they used to be.
31073 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
31074 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31075 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
31076 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
31077 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
31078 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
31079 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
31080 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
31081 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
31082 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
31083 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
31084 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
31085 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
31087 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
31088 option), this condition is always true.
31091 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
31092 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
31093 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
31094 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
31095 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
31096 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
31097 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
31098 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
31099 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
31102 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
31103 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
31106 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
31107 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
31110 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
31111 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31112 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
31113 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
31114 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
31115 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31116 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
31117 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31118 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31119 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31120 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31121 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31122 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31123 value for the child address.
31125 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31126 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31127 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31128 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31129 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31130 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31131 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31132 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31133 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31134 original IP address.
31136 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31137 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31139 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31140 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31142 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31143 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31144 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31145 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
31146 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
31147 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31148 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31149 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31150 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31152 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31153 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31154 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31155 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31156 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31157 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31158 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31160 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31161 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31162 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31164 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31165 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31166 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31167 verified as a sender.
31169 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31170 (eg. is generated from the received message)
31171 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31173 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31179 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31180 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31181 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
31182 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31183 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31184 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31185 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31186 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31187 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31188 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31190 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31191 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31193 the following records are looked up:
31195 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31196 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31198 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31199 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31200 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31201 use two separate conditions:
31203 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31204 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31206 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31207 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31208 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31211 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31212 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31213 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31214 following special items in the list:
31216 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31217 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31218 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31220 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31221 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31222 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31223 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31225 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31227 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31228 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31230 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31231 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31232 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31234 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31236 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31237 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31238 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31239 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31240 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31241 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31243 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31244 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31245 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31249 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31250 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31251 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31252 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31253 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31255 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31257 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31258 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31259 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31260 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31265 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31266 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31267 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31268 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31269 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31270 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31271 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31273 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31274 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31276 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31277 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31278 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31279 up by this example is
31281 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31283 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31284 addresses. For example:
31286 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31287 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31289 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31290 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31295 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31296 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31297 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31298 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31299 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31300 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31301 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31302 either to double the separators like this:
31304 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31306 or to change the separator character, like this:
31308 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31310 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31311 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31312 occurs. Consider this condition:
31314 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31316 The DNS lookups that occur are:
31318 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31319 a.domain.black.list.tld
31321 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31322 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31323 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31324 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31325 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31326 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31327 error for a previous item.
31329 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31330 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31332 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31333 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31335 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31336 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31338 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31339 $sender_address_domain \
31340 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31342 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31343 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31344 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31346 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31347 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31348 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31349 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31351 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31353 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31354 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31356 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31357 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31362 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31363 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31364 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31365 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31366 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31367 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31371 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31373 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31374 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31375 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31377 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31378 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31379 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31382 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31383 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31384 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31385 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31386 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31387 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31388 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31389 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31390 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31391 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31392 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31393 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31394 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31395 cases, for example:
31397 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31399 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31400 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31401 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31402 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31404 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31406 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31407 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31409 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31410 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31411 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31412 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31413 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31416 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31417 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31418 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31420 deny hosts = !+local_networks
31421 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31423 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31428 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31429 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31430 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31431 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31434 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31436 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31437 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31438 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31439 describes how multiple records are handled.
31441 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31442 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31443 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31445 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31447 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31448 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31449 first. For example:
31451 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31452 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31455 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31456 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31457 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31458 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31459 tested. For example:
31461 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31463 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31464 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31465 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31467 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31469 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31474 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31475 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31478 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31480 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31481 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31483 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31485 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31486 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31487 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31488 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31490 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31491 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31493 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31494 previous example is precisely equivalent to
31496 deny dnslists = a.b.c
31497 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31499 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31500 Consider this example:
31502 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31504 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31507 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31509 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31511 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31512 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31513 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31515 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31520 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31521 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31522 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31523 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31524 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31525 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31527 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31529 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31530 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31531 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31532 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31533 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31534 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31537 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31538 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31539 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31541 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31542 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31545 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31547 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31548 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31550 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31552 for the condition to be true.
31555 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31556 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31558 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31559 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31561 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31563 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31564 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31566 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31567 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31569 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31571 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31572 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31574 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31576 for the condition to be false.
31578 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31579 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31584 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31585 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31586 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31587 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31588 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31589 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31590 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31591 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31592 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31595 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31596 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31597 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31598 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31599 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31600 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31601 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31604 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31605 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31607 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31608 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31610 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31611 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31612 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31613 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31614 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31615 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31617 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31618 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31619 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31622 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31623 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31624 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31625 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31627 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31628 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31629 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31633 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31634 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31635 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31636 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31637 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
31638 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31640 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31641 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31643 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31644 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31645 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31647 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31649 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31650 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31652 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31653 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31655 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31656 dnslists = some.list.example
31659 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31660 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31661 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31663 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31666 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31667 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31668 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31669 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31670 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31671 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31672 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31673 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31674 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31675 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31677 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31679 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31680 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31682 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31683 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31684 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31687 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31688 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31689 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31690 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31691 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31692 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31693 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31694 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31695 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31697 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31698 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31699 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31700 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31702 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31703 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31704 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31705 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31706 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31707 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31708 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31709 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31710 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31711 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31713 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31714 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31715 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31718 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31719 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
31720 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31721 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31722 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31723 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31725 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31726 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31727 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31728 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31729 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31730 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31731 the &%count=%& option.
31734 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31735 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31736 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31737 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31738 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31740 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31741 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31742 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31743 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31745 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31746 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31747 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31748 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31749 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31750 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31751 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31753 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31754 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31755 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31756 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31757 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31758 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31759 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31761 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31762 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31763 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31764 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31767 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31768 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31769 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31770 multiple different commands.
31772 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31773 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31774 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31775 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31776 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31778 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31781 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31782 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31783 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31784 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31785 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31787 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31788 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31790 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31791 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31792 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31793 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31797 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31798 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31799 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31802 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31803 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31804 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31807 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31808 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31809 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31810 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31811 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31812 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31815 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31816 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31817 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31818 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31819 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31822 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31823 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31824 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31825 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31826 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31827 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31830 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31831 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31832 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31833 up to the given limit.
31834 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31835 consists of refusing the message, and
31836 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31837 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31838 likely not what is wanted.
31840 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31841 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31842 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31843 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31844 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31845 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31846 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31847 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31849 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31853 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31854 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31855 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31856 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31857 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31858 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31859 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31860 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31861 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31863 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31864 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31865 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31866 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31867 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31868 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31870 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31871 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31874 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31875 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31876 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31877 required increases with larger limits.
31879 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31880 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31881 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31882 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31883 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31884 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31885 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31886 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31887 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31891 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31892 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31893 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31894 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31895 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31896 message. For example:
31898 # Log all senders' rates
31899 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31900 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31902 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31903 # at the decimal point.
31904 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31905 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31906 $sender_rate_limit }s
31908 # Keep authenticated users under control
31909 deny authenticated = *
31910 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31912 # System-wide rate limit
31913 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31914 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31916 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31917 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31918 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31919 messages per $sender_rate_period
31920 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31921 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31922 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31924 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31925 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31926 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31927 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31928 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31929 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31930 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31934 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31935 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31936 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31937 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31938 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31939 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31940 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31941 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31942 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31944 verify = sender/callout
31945 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31947 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31948 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31949 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31950 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31951 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31952 The available options are as follows:
31955 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31956 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31957 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31959 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31960 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31961 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31962 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31964 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31965 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31967 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31968 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31969 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31970 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31973 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31974 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31975 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31976 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31977 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31978 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31981 warn !verify = sender
31982 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31984 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31985 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31986 verification failure.
31988 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31989 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31992 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31993 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31995 &%route%&: Routing failed.
31997 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31998 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31999 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
32001 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
32003 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
32006 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
32007 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
32009 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
32010 address verification to:
32013 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
32019 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
32020 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
32021 .cindex "callout" "verification"
32022 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
32023 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
32024 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
32025 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
32026 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
32027 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
32028 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
32029 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
32030 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
32033 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
32034 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
32035 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
32036 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
32037 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
32038 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
32040 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
32041 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
32042 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
32043 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
32044 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
32046 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
32047 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
32048 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
32049 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
32050 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
32051 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
32052 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
32053 supplies a host list.
32054 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
32056 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
32057 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
32058 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
32059 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
32060 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
32061 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
32062 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
32064 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
32065 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
32066 following SMTP commands are sent:
32068 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
32070 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
32073 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
32076 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
32079 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
32080 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
32081 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
32082 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
32083 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
32084 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
32086 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
32087 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
32088 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
32089 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
32090 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
32092 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32093 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
32094 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
32095 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
32096 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
32101 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
32102 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
32103 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
32104 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
32106 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
32108 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
32109 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
32110 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
32114 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
32115 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
32116 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32119 verify = sender/callout=5s
32121 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32122 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32123 the &%connect%& parameter.
32126 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32127 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32128 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32129 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32131 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32133 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32135 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
32136 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32137 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32138 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32139 updated in this circumstance.
32141 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32142 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32143 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32144 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32145 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32146 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32149 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32150 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32151 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32152 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32153 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32154 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32155 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32156 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32157 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32158 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32160 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32162 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32165 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32166 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32167 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32170 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32172 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32173 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32174 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32175 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32176 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
32179 .vitem &*no_cache*&
32180 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32181 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32182 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32184 .vitem &*postmaster*&
32185 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32186 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32187 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32188 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32189 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32190 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32191 made, until the cache record expires.
32193 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32194 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32195 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32198 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32200 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32201 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32203 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32205 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32206 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32207 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32208 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32212 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32213 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32214 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32215 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32216 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32218 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32220 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32221 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32222 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32223 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32224 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32226 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32227 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32228 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32230 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32232 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32233 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32234 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32235 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32236 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32238 .vitem &*use_sender*&
32239 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32241 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32243 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32244 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32245 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32246 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32247 usefulness of callout caching.
32250 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32252 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32254 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32255 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32256 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32257 when that is used for the connections.
32258 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32259 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32260 if the use_sender option is used,
32261 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32262 and if no other callouts intervene.
32265 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32266 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32267 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32268 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32269 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32270 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32271 these circumstances.
32273 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32274 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32275 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32276 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32277 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32278 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32279 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32281 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32282 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32283 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32284 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32289 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32290 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32291 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32292 .cindex "caching" "callout"
32293 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32294 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32295 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32296 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32297 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32298 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32300 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32301 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32304 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32305 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32306 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32308 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32309 commands up to and including
32313 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32314 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32315 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32316 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32317 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32318 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32319 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32321 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32322 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32323 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32324 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32325 will eventually be noticed.
32327 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32328 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32329 behaviour will be the same.
32333 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32334 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32335 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32336 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32337 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32338 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32341 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32343 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32344 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32345 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32346 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32347 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32348 550 Sender verification failed
32350 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32351 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32352 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32353 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32356 verify = sender/no_details
32359 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32360 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32361 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32362 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32363 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32364 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32365 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32368 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32369 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32370 verification also fails.
32372 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32373 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32376 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32377 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32378 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32381 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32383 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32384 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32385 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32386 verification to succeed.
32388 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32389 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32390 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32391 option. For example:
32393 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32395 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32396 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32398 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32399 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32400 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32401 address and a report is output for each of them.
32405 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32406 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32407 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32408 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32409 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32410 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32411 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32415 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32416 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32417 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32418 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32419 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32420 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32422 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32423 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32424 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32425 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32428 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32430 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32432 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32433 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32435 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32436 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32439 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32440 use for the DNS query. The default is:
32442 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32444 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32445 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32446 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32447 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32450 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32452 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32453 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32454 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32456 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32457 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32458 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32459 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32460 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32461 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32462 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32463 of legitimate HELO domains.
32465 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32466 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32467 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32468 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32471 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32473 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32474 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32475 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32480 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32481 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
32482 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32483 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32484 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32485 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32486 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32487 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32489 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32490 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32491 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32492 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32493 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32494 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32495 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32496 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32498 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32499 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32502 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32503 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32506 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32507 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32510 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32511 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32513 recipients = +batv_senders
32515 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32516 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32518 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32519 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32520 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32522 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32523 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32524 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32525 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32526 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32528 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32529 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32530 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32531 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32532 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32533 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32534 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32536 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32537 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32538 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32539 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32543 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32545 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32546 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32547 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32550 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32553 external_smtp_batv:
32555 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32556 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32557 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32558 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32561 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32565 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32566 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32567 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32568 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32569 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32570 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32571 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32572 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32573 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32574 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32576 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32577 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32578 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32579 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32580 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32581 same host is fulfilling both functions,
32583 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
32585 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32586 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32587 system to arbitrary domains.
32590 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32591 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32592 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32593 example, suppose you want to do the following:
32596 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32597 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32598 &'my.dom2.example'&.
32600 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32601 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32603 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32604 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32608 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32610 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32611 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32612 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32614 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32618 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32619 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32621 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32622 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32623 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32624 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32625 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32626 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32627 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32631 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32632 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32633 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32634 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32635 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32640 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32641 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32643 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32644 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32645 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32646 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32647 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32648 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32651 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32652 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32653 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32654 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32655 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32657 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32658 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32659 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32662 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32663 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32665 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32666 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32667 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32669 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32670 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32672 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32675 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32678 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32679 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32680 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32681 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32682 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32683 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32685 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32686 temporarily created in a file called:
32688 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32690 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32691 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32692 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32693 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32694 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32696 control = no_mbox_unspool
32698 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32699 same directory by default.
32703 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32704 .cindex "virus scanning"
32705 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32706 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32707 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32708 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32709 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32710 in memory and thus are much faster.
32713 Since message data needs to have arrived,
32714 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
32716 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
32717 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
32721 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32722 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32724 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32725 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32726 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32727 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32729 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32731 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32733 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32735 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32737 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32738 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32739 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32743 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32744 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32745 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32746 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32747 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32748 This scanner type takes one option,
32749 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32750 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32751 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32752 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32753 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32754 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32755 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32757 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32758 If &`pass_unscanned`&
32759 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32760 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32765 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32766 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32767 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32769 If you omit the argument, the default path
32770 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32772 If you use a remote host,
32773 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32774 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32775 For information about available commands and their options you may use
32777 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32783 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32784 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32785 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32787 .vitem &%aveserver%&
32788 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32789 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32790 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32791 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32794 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32799 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32800 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32801 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32802 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32803 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32805 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32806 a UNIX socket specification,
32807 a TCP socket specification,
32808 or a (global) option.
32810 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32811 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32812 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32813 and the second a port number,
32814 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32815 These per-server options are supported:
32817 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32820 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32821 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32823 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32827 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32828 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32829 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32830 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32831 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32833 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32835 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32836 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32837 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32838 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32840 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32841 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32842 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32843 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32844 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32845 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32846 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32847 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32848 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32850 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32851 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32852 (Connection refused)
32855 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32856 contributing the code for this scanner.
32859 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32860 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32861 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32862 type takes 3 mandatory options:
32865 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32866 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32869 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32870 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32871 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32872 the &"trigger"& expression.
32875 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32876 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32877 &"name"& expression.
32880 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32882 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32884 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32885 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32886 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32887 configuration setting:
32889 av_scanner = cmdline:\
32890 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32891 found in file:'(.+)'
32894 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32895 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
32897 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32898 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32899 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32900 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32903 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32904 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32906 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32907 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32910 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32911 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32912 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32916 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32918 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32920 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32921 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32922 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32923 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32926 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32928 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32931 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32932 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
32933 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32935 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32937 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32938 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32940 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32941 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32942 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32943 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32944 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32947 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32949 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32952 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32953 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
32954 though some documentation was available in English.
32955 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
32956 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
32957 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
32959 The only option for this scanner type is
32960 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32961 provided that mksd has
32962 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32964 av_scanner = mksd:2
32966 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32969 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32970 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32971 running on the local machine.
32972 There are four options:
32973 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32974 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32975 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32976 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32977 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32980 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32982 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32983 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32984 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32985 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32986 specify an empty element to get this.
32989 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32990 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32991 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
32992 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32993 client communication. For example:
32995 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32997 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
33001 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
33002 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
33005 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
33006 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
33007 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
33008 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
33009 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
33010 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
33013 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
33014 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
33015 The first element can then be one of
33018 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
33019 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
33022 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
33023 the condition fails immediately.
33025 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
33026 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
33027 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
33028 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
33029 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
33032 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
33033 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
33034 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
33036 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
33037 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
33040 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
33042 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
33044 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33045 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33046 is set to record the actual address used.
33048 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
33049 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
33050 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
33051 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
33054 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
33055 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
33057 Here is a very simple scanning example:
33059 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33062 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
33064 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33065 malware = */defer_ok
33067 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
33068 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
33070 av_scanner = $acl_m0
33072 in the main Exim configuration.
33074 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33075 set acl_m0 = sophie
33078 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33079 set acl_m0 = aveserver
33084 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
33085 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
33086 .cindex "spam scanning"
33087 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
33089 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
33090 score and a report for the message.
33091 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
33093 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
33094 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
33095 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
33097 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
33099 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
33101 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
33102 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
33105 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
33106 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
33107 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
33108 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
33109 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
33110 configuration as follows (example):
33112 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
33114 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
33115 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
33116 iptables firewall, consider setting
33117 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
33118 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
33119 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
33120 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
33124 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
33126 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33128 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33131 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33132 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33133 filename instead of an address/port pair:
33135 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33137 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33138 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33139 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33140 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33142 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33143 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33146 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33147 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33148 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33151 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33152 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33153 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33154 take care to not double the separator.
33156 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33157 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33158 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33159 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33161 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33163 The supported options are:
33165 pri=<priority> Selection priority
33166 weight=<value> Selection bias
33167 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33168 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33169 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33170 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33173 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33174 higher values being tried first.
33175 The default priority is 1.
33177 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33178 Within a priority set
33179 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33180 The default value for selection bias is 1.
33182 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33183 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33184 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33185 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33187 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33188 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33190 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33191 The default value is two minutes.
33193 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33194 a failed connect is made.
33195 The default is to not retry.
33197 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33198 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33199 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33202 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33203 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33204 is set to record the actual address used.
33206 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33207 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33209 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33212 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33213 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33214 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33215 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33216 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33219 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33220 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33221 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33222 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33223 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33225 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33226 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33228 or the use of PRDR,
33229 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33230 are needed to use this feature.
33232 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33233 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33234 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33237 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33238 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33239 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33242 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33243 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33247 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33248 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33249 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33250 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33252 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33253 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33255 Except for &$spam_report$&,
33256 these variables are saved with the received message so are
33257 available for use at delivery time.
33260 .vitem &$spam_score$&
33261 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33262 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33264 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33265 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33266 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33267 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33268 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33270 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
33271 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33272 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33273 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33274 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33275 spam bar is 50 characters.
33277 .vitem &$spam_report$&
33278 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33279 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33280 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33281 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33282 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33283 unencoded in headers.
33285 .vitem &$spam_action$&
33286 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33287 spam score versus threshold.
33288 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33292 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33293 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33294 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33296 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33297 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33298 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33299 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33300 spam condition, like this:
33302 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33303 spam = joe/defer_ok
33305 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33307 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33310 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33311 warn spam = nobody:true
33312 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33313 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33315 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33316 # is over threshold
33318 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33320 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33321 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33323 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33328 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33329 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33330 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
33331 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33332 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33333 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33334 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33335 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33336 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33337 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33340 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33341 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33342 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33343 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33344 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33345 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33346 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33348 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33349 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33350 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33351 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33352 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33354 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33355 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33356 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33357 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33358 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33361 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33363 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33367 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33369 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33370 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33371 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33372 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33374 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33375 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33376 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33377 the full path and filename.
33379 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33380 filename, and the default path is then used.
33382 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33383 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33384 a file with its original, proposed filename using
33386 decode = $mime_filename
33388 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33389 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33390 automatically unlinked.
33392 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33393 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33394 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33395 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33396 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33398 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33399 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33400 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33402 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33403 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33404 available in the MIME ACL:
33407 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33408 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
33409 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33410 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33411 contains the empty string.
33413 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
33414 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33415 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33421 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33422 case-insensitively.
33424 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33425 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33426 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33427 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33428 only used for display purposes.
33430 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33431 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33432 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33434 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33435 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33436 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33438 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33439 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33440 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33441 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33442 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33444 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33445 This variable contains the normalized content of the
33446 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33447 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33449 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33450 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33451 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33452 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33456 application/octet-stream
33460 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33463 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33464 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33465 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33466 containing the decoded data.
33471 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
33472 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33473 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33474 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33477 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33479 found, this variable contains the empty string.
33481 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33482 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33483 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33484 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33486 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33487 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33491 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33494 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33495 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33498 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33499 and the rest are attachments.
33502 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33505 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33506 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33507 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33509 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33510 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33511 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33512 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33514 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33515 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33516 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33517 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33518 want to carry out specific actions on them.
33520 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33521 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33522 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33523 decoding is fully recursive.
33525 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33526 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33527 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33528 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33529 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33530 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33531 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33536 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33537 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33538 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33539 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33540 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33542 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33543 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33544 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33545 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33546 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33548 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33549 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33550 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33551 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33552 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
33553 32K characters are checked.
33555 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33556 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33557 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33558 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33559 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33561 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33562 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33564 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33565 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33566 matching regular expression.
33567 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33568 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33570 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33578 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33579 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33581 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33582 "Local scan function"
33583 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33584 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33585 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33586 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33587 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33589 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33590 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33591 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33592 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33593 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33595 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33596 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33597 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33598 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33600 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33601 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33602 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33603 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33605 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33606 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33607 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33608 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33609 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33610 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33611 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33612 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33613 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33617 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33618 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33619 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33620 function is before building Exim, by setting
33621 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33622 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33623 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33624 directory, so you might set
33626 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33627 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33629 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
33630 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33631 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33632 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33633 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33634 _src/local_scan.c_.
33636 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33637 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33639 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33641 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33646 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33647 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33648 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
33649 You must include this line near the start of your code:
33651 #include "local_scan.h"
33653 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33654 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33655 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33656 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33657 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33658 strings and pointers to character strings:
33660 #define CS (char *)
33661 #define CCS (const char *)
33662 #define CSS (char **)
33663 #define US (unsigned char *)
33664 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33665 #define USS (unsigned char **)
33667 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33669 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33671 The arguments are as follows:
33674 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33675 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33676 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33678 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33679 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33680 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33681 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33682 case this changes in some future version.
33684 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33685 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33688 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33691 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33692 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33693 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33694 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33695 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33696 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33698 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33699 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33700 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33702 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33703 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33704 queued without immediate delivery.
33706 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33707 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33708 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33709 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33710 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33713 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33714 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33715 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33718 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33719 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33720 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33721 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33722 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33723 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33724 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33726 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33727 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33728 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33731 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33732 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33733 &%-oe%& command line options.
33737 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33738 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33739 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33740 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33741 want to do this, you must have the line
33743 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33745 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33746 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33747 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33750 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33751 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33752 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33753 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33754 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33755 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33757 static int my_integer_option = 42;
33758 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33760 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33761 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33762 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33765 int local_scan_options_count =
33766 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33768 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33769 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33773 my_string = some string of text...
33775 The available types of option data are as follows:
33778 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
33779 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33780 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33781 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33782 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33783 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33786 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33787 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33788 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33789 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33792 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33793 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33796 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33797 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33798 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33799 printed with the suffix K or M.
33801 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
33802 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33803 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33804 always output in octal.
33806 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33807 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33808 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33810 .vitem &*opt_time*&
33811 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33812 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33815 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33816 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33820 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33821 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33822 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33823 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33824 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33825 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33826 C variables are as follows:
33829 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33830 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33831 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33833 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33834 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33835 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33837 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33838 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33839 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33840 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33843 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33844 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33845 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33848 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33849 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33853 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33854 selected, you should use code like this:
33856 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33857 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33859 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33860 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33861 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33863 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33864 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33867 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33868 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33870 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33871 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33873 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33874 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33875 &%-bh%& command line option.
33877 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33878 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33879 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33881 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33882 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33883 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33884 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33886 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33887 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33888 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33890 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33891 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33893 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33894 The number of accepted recipients.
33896 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33897 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33898 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33899 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33900 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33901 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33902 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33903 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33904 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33905 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33906 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33907 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33909 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33910 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33912 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33913 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33914 locally-submitted messages.
33916 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33917 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33918 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33920 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33921 The name of the sending host, if known.
33923 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33924 The port on the sending host.
33926 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33927 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33929 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33930 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33932 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33933 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33934 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33938 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33939 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33940 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33941 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33946 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33947 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33949 .vitem &*int&~type*&
33950 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33951 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33952 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33953 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33954 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33955 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33957 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
33958 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33961 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33962 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33963 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33968 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33969 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33972 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33973 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33975 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
33976 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33977 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33978 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33980 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33981 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33982 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33983 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33984 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33985 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33986 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33987 is NULL for all recipients.
33992 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33993 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33994 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33995 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33999 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
34000 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
34002 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
34003 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
34004 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
34005 for the process in &%newumask%&.
34007 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
34008 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
34009 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
34010 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
34011 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
34013 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
34015 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
34016 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
34017 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
34018 return value is as follows:
34023 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
34029 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
34035 The process timed out.
34039 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
34042 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
34043 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
34044 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
34045 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
34046 forks a subprocess that is running
34048 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
34050 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
34051 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
34052 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
34053 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
34055 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
34056 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
34057 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
34058 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
34061 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
34062 *sender_authentication)*&
34063 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
34066 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
34068 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
34071 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34072 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
34073 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
34074 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
34075 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
34077 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34078 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34081 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
34082 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
34083 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
34084 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
34085 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
34086 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
34087 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
34088 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
34090 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
34091 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
34092 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
34093 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
34094 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
34095 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
34097 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34098 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
34099 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
34100 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
34102 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
34103 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
34104 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
34105 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
34106 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
34107 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
34108 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
34109 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
34110 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
34111 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
34113 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
34114 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
34116 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
34117 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
34120 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
34121 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
34122 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
34123 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
34124 match the specification, the function does nothing.
34127 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34128 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34129 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34130 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34131 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34132 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34134 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34136 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34137 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34138 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34139 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34140 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34143 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34144 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34145 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34146 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34147 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34148 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34149 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34150 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34152 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34153 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34154 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34156 &`OK `& match succeeded
34157 &`FAIL `& match failed
34158 &`DEFER `& match deferred
34160 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34161 inability to contact a database.
34163 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34165 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34166 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34167 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34169 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34171 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34172 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34173 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34175 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34177 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34180 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34182 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34183 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34184 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34185 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34186 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34187 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34190 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34192 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34193 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34194 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34195 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34196 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34197 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34200 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34201 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34202 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34203 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34205 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34206 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34207 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34208 value afterwards. For example:
34210 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34211 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34212 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34215 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34216 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34217 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34218 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34225 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34226 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34227 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34228 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34229 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34230 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34231 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34232 binary string is returned with an error message.
34234 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34235 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34236 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34238 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34239 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34240 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34241 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34242 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34244 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34245 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34246 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34248 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34249 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34250 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34251 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34255 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34256 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34259 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34260 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34261 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34262 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34263 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34264 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34265 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34266 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34269 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34270 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34272 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34273 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34274 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34275 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34276 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34277 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34278 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34280 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34281 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34283 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34284 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34285 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34286 multiple output lines.
34288 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34289 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
34290 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34291 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34292 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34293 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34294 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34297 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
34298 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34299 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
34300 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34302 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
34303 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34304 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34306 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34309 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34312 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34313 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34314 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34315 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34316 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34317 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34323 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34324 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34325 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34326 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34327 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34328 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34329 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34332 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34333 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34334 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34335 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34337 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34338 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34340 store_pool = POOL_PERM
34342 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34343 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34344 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34345 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34347 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34348 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34349 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34350 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34357 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34358 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34360 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34361 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34362 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34363 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34364 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34365 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34366 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34367 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34369 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34370 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34371 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34372 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34373 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34375 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34376 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34377 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34378 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34379 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34380 prevent it happening on retries.
34382 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34383 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34384 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34385 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34386 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34387 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34388 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34389 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34392 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34393 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34394 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34395 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34396 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34397 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34398 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34400 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34401 system_filter_user = exim
34403 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34404 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34405 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34406 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34407 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34408 by the &%reply%& command.
34411 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34412 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34413 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34414 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34416 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34417 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34421 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34422 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34423 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34424 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34425 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34426 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34429 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34430 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34431 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34432 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34433 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34434 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34435 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34437 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34438 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34439 succeed, it will not be tried again.
34440 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34441 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34443 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34444 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34445 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34446 to which users' filter files can refer.
34450 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34451 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
34452 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34453 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34454 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34458 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34459 .cindex "freezing messages"
34460 .cindex "message" "freezing"
34461 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
34462 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34463 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34464 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34465 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34466 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34467 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34468 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34469 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34471 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34473 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34475 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34476 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34477 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34478 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34479 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34482 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34483 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34484 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34485 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34487 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34488 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34489 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34490 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34491 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34492 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34493 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34494 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34495 message. For example:
34497 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34498 because it contains attachments that we are \
34499 not prepared to receive."
34502 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34503 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34504 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34505 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34506 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34507 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34510 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34511 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34513 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34514 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34515 generated by the filter.
34517 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34519 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34520 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34526 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34527 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34532 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34533 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34534 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34535 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34536 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34538 headers add <string>
34539 headers remove <string>
34541 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34542 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34543 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34544 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34545 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34547 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34548 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34549 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34552 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34553 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34556 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34557 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34558 space after input continuations is ignored.
34560 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34561 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34562 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34563 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34564 header with the same name, they are all removed.
34566 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34567 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34568 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34569 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34570 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34571 used for all recipients of the message.
34573 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34574 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34575 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34576 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34577 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34578 until the message is actually being written (see section
34579 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34581 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34582 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34583 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34584 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34585 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34586 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34587 modified more than once.
34589 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34590 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34593 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34594 headers remove "Subject"
34595 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34596 headers remove "Old-Subject"
34601 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34602 .cindex "envelope from"
34603 .cindex "envelope sender"
34604 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34606 errors_to <some address>
34608 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34609 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34610 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34613 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34615 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34616 address if its delivery failed.
34620 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34621 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34622 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34623 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34624 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34625 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34626 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34627 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34628 which implements such a filter:
34633 domains = +local_domains
34634 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34639 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34640 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34641 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34642 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34644 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34645 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34646 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34647 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34649 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
34650 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
34651 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
34658 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34659 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34661 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34662 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34663 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34664 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34665 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34666 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34667 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34668 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34670 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34671 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34672 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34673 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34674 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34676 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34677 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34678 loopback interface specially in any way.
34680 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34681 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34686 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34687 .cindex "message" "submission"
34688 .cindex "submission mode"
34689 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34690 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34691 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34692 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34694 control = submission
34696 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34697 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34698 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34699 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34700 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34701 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34703 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34704 control = submission
34706 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34707 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34708 is used to separate options. For example:
34710 control = submission/sender_retain
34712 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34713 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34714 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34715 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34716 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34717 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34718 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34720 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34721 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34724 control = submission/domain=some.domain
34726 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34727 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34728 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34729 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34731 accept authenticated = *
34732 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34733 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34734 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34736 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34737 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34738 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34740 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34742 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34745 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34747 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34748 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34749 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34750 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34752 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34753 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34754 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34755 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34756 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34757 spoof another's address.
34759 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34760 .cindex "line endings"
34761 .cindex "carriage return"
34763 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34764 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34765 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34766 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34767 use CRLF or just CR.
34769 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34770 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34771 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34772 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34773 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34774 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34775 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34776 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34780 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34782 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34785 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34786 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34789 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34790 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34791 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34792 people trying to play silly games.
34794 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34795 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34803 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34804 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
34805 .cindex "address" "qualification"
34806 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34807 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34808 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34809 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34810 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34812 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34813 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34814 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34815 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34816 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34818 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34819 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34820 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34821 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34822 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34823 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34824 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34825 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34830 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34831 .cindex "&""From""& line"
34832 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34833 .cindex "sender" "address"
34834 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34835 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34836 .cindex "envelope from"
34837 .cindex "envelope sender"
34838 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34839 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34840 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34841 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34843 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34844 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34846 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34847 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34848 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34849 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34850 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34851 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34852 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34853 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34854 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34856 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34857 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34858 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34859 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34860 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34861 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34862 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34864 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34865 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34866 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34868 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34869 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34870 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34871 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34875 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34876 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34877 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34878 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34879 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34880 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34881 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34882 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34885 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34886 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34889 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34890 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34894 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34895 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34897 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34898 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34899 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34901 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34904 For a locally-submitted message,
34905 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34906 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34907 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34908 included in log lines in this case.
34910 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34911 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34917 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34918 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34919 includes the header line:
34921 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34924 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34925 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34926 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34927 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34928 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34929 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34932 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34933 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34934 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34935 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34936 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34937 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34939 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34940 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34941 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34942 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34943 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34944 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34945 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34946 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34950 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34951 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34952 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34953 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34954 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34955 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34956 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34957 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34958 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34962 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34963 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34964 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
34965 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34966 .cindex "message" "submission"
34967 .cindex "submission mode"
34968 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34969 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34972 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34973 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34975 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34976 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34978 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34979 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34980 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34982 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34983 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34985 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34986 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34990 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34992 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34993 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34994 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34995 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34996 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34997 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34998 &%qualify_domain%&.
35000 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
35001 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
35002 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
35003 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35006 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
35007 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
35008 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
35009 .cindex "message" "submission"
35010 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
35011 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
35012 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
35013 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
35014 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
35015 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
35016 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
35017 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
35018 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
35019 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
35022 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
35023 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
35024 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
35025 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
35026 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
35027 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
35029 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
35030 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
35031 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
35032 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
35034 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
35035 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
35036 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
35039 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
35040 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
35041 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
35042 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
35043 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
35044 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
35045 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
35046 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
35047 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
35048 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
35049 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
35050 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
35054 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
35055 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
35056 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
35057 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
35058 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
35059 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
35060 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
35061 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
35062 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
35066 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
35067 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
35068 .cindex "message" "submission"
35069 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
35070 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
35071 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
35072 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
35073 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35076 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
35077 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35078 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
35079 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
35080 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
35081 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
35082 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
35083 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
35084 line is added to the message.
35086 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
35087 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
35088 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
35089 options true at the same time.
35091 .cindex "submission mode"
35092 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
35093 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
35094 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
35095 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
35097 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35098 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
35099 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
35100 created as follows:
35103 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35104 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35105 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35107 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
35108 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35110 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35111 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35114 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
35115 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
35116 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
35117 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
35119 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
35120 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
35121 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
35122 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
35126 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35127 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35128 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35129 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35130 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35131 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35132 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35133 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35134 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35136 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35137 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35138 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35139 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35140 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35141 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35143 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35144 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35145 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35147 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35148 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35149 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35151 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35152 X-added-second: another added header line
35154 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35156 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35157 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35158 Each header-line is separately expanded.
35160 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35161 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35162 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35163 not part of the names. For example:
35165 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35168 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35169 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35170 Each item is separately expanded.
35171 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35172 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35173 will act as list separators.
35175 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35176 items are expanded at routing time,
35177 and then associated with all addresses that are
35178 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35179 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35180 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35182 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
35183 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35184 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35185 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35187 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35188 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35189 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35192 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35193 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35194 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35195 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35196 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35197 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35198 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35200 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35201 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35202 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35203 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35205 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35206 the following consequences:
35209 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35210 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35211 to it, at all times.
35213 Header lines that are added by a router's
35214 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35215 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35217 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35218 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35220 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35221 a later router or by a transport.
35223 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35224 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35226 headers_remove = subject
35227 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35231 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35232 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35238 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35239 .cindex "address" "constructed"
35240 .cindex "constructed address"
35241 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35244 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35248 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35250 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35251 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35252 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35253 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35254 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35255 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35256 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35257 there is no password file entry.
35260 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35261 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35262 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35263 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35264 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35265 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35266 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35267 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35271 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35272 .cindex "case of local parts"
35273 .cindex "local part" "case of"
35274 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35275 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35276 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35277 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35278 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35279 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35282 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
35283 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35284 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35285 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35286 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35290 domains = +local_domains
35291 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35292 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35295 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35296 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35297 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35298 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35299 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35303 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35304 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
35305 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
35306 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35307 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35308 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35309 empty components for compatibility.
35313 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35314 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35315 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35316 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35317 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35318 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35320 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35321 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35322 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35323 example, a header such as
35327 might get rewritten as
35329 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35331 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35332 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35335 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35336 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35337 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35338 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35339 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35340 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35341 .ecindex IIDmesproc
35345 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35346 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35348 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35349 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35350 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35351 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35352 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35353 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35354 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35357 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35359 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35361 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35364 For mail delivery, the following are available:
35367 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35369 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35372 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35375 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35376 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35379 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35380 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35381 used to contain the envelope information.
35385 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35386 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35387 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35388 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35389 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35392 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35393 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35394 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35395 processing is the same in both cases.
35397 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35398 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35399 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35400 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35401 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35402 .cindex "transport" "filter"
35403 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35404 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35407 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35408 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35409 required for the transaction.
35411 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35412 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35413 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35414 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35415 is called for verification.
35417 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35418 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35419 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35421 .cindex "carriage return"
35423 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35424 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35425 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35428 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35429 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35430 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35431 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35432 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35433 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35434 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35435 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35436 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35438 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35439 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35440 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35441 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35443 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35444 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35445 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35446 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35448 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35449 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35450 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35451 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35452 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35453 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35454 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35455 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35456 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35457 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35459 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35460 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35462 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35463 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35464 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35465 square bracket of the IP address.
35470 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35471 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35472 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35473 .cindex "host" "error"
35474 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35475 message errors, and recipient errors.
35478 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35479 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35480 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35483 Connection refused or timed out,
35485 Any error response code on connection,
35487 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35489 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35491 I/O errors at any time,
35493 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35494 the &"."& at the end of the data.
35497 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35498 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35499 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35500 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35501 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35502 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35503 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35504 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35506 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35507 .cindex "message" "error"
35508 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35509 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35510 message errors are:
35513 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35516 Timeout after MAIL,
35518 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35519 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35520 connection at any other time.
35523 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35524 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35525 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35526 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35527 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35528 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35529 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35530 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35531 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35532 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35534 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35535 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35536 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35539 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35540 .cindex "recipient" "error"
35541 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35542 recipient errors are:
35545 Any error response to RCPT,
35547 Timeout after RCPT.
35550 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35551 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35552 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35553 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35554 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35555 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35556 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35557 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35558 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35559 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35560 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35561 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35562 the retry clock is reset.
35564 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35565 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35566 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35567 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35568 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35569 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35570 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35571 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35572 recipient's retry time.
35575 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35576 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35577 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35578 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35579 until the next delivery attempt.
35581 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35582 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35583 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35584 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35585 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35588 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35589 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35590 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35591 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35592 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35593 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35594 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35596 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35597 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35598 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35599 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35600 then to be treated as a host error.
35602 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35603 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35604 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35605 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35606 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35611 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35612 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35613 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35616 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35617 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35618 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35620 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35622 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35623 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35624 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35625 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35626 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35627 stream and exits with an error code.
35629 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35630 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35631 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35632 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35634 .cindex "carriage return"
35636 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35637 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35638 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35640 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35641 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35642 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35644 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35645 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35646 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35647 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35648 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35649 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35650 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35651 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35653 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35654 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35655 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35656 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35657 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35658 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35659 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35660 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35661 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35663 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35664 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35665 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35667 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35668 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35669 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35670 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35671 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35673 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35674 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35675 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35676 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35677 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35678 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35679 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35681 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35682 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35683 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35684 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35685 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35687 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35688 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35689 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35690 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35691 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35692 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35693 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35694 a delivery process.
35696 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35697 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35698 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35699 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35700 however, available with &'inetd'&.
35702 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35703 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35704 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35705 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35707 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35708 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35709 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35713 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35714 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35715 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35716 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35717 the error response to the last command. The default value for
35718 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35719 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35720 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35723 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35724 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35725 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35726 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35727 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35728 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35729 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35730 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35731 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35732 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35733 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35737 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35738 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35739 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35740 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35741 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35742 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35743 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35744 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35746 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35747 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35748 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35749 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35750 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35753 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35754 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35755 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35757 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35758 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35759 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35760 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35761 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35766 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35767 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35768 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35769 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35771 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35772 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35773 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35774 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
35775 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35776 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35777 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35778 SMTP response codes.
35780 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35781 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35782 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35783 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35784 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35785 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35786 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35787 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35792 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35793 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35794 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35795 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35796 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35797 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35798 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35800 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35801 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35802 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35803 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35804 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35805 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35806 argument. For example,
35814 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35815 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35816 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35817 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35818 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35820 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35821 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35822 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35823 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35824 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35825 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35826 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35827 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35829 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35830 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35831 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35832 whatever the form of its argument. For
35835 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35836 $sender_host_address
35838 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35839 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35840 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35841 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35842 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35843 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35844 for it to change them before running the command.
35848 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35849 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35850 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35851 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35852 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35853 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35854 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35855 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35856 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35857 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35858 runs for RCPT commands:
35862 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35866 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35867 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35868 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
35869 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35870 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35871 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35872 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35873 envelope along with the message.
35875 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35876 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35877 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35878 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35879 can be used to specify it.
35881 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35882 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35883 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35884 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35885 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35888 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35889 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35890 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35895 driver = manualroute
35896 transport = smtp_appendfile
35897 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35901 driver = appendfile
35902 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35907 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35908 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35909 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35913 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35914 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35915 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
35916 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35917 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35918 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35919 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35920 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35921 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35922 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35924 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35925 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35927 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35928 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35929 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35930 make some use of automatically, for example:
35932 554 Unexpected end of file
35933 Transaction started in line 10
35934 Error detected in line 14
35936 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35939 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35940 The error message was:
35942 501 '>' missing at end of address
35944 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35945 The error was detected in line 12.
35946 The SMTP command at fault was:
35948 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35950 1 previous message was successfully processed.
35951 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35953 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35954 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35956 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35957 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35961 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35962 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35964 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35965 "Customizing messages"
35966 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
35967 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35968 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35969 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35970 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35972 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35973 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35974 option. Exim also adds the line
35976 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35978 to all warning and bounce messages,
35981 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35982 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35983 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35984 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35985 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35986 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35987 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35989 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35990 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35991 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35992 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35993 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35996 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35997 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35998 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35999 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
36000 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
36001 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
36002 option, rounded to a whole number.
36004 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
36007 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36008 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36010 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
36011 failing addresses with their error messages.
36013 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
36014 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
36016 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
36017 The fields exist for back-compatibility
36020 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
36021 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
36022 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
36024 Subject: Mail delivery failed
36025 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36026 {: returning message to sender}}
36028 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36030 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36031 {that you sent }{sent by
36035 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
36036 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
36038 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
36040 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
36043 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
36045 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
36048 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
36049 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
36050 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
36051 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
36052 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
36056 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36057 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36059 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
36060 the delayed addresses.
36062 The third item then ends the message.
36065 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
36066 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
36068 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
36069 $warn_message_delay
36071 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36073 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
36074 {that you sent }{sent by
36078 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
36079 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
36081 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
36082 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
36083 The date of the message is: $h_date
36085 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
36087 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
36088 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
36089 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
36090 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
36091 the message will be returned to you.
36093 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
36094 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
36095 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
36096 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
36097 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
36098 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
36099 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
36100 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
36106 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36107 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36109 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
36110 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
36111 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
36115 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
36116 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
36117 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
36118 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
36119 routing explicitly:
36121 send_to_smart_host:
36122 driver = manualroute
36123 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
36124 transport = remote_smtp
36126 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36127 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36128 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36129 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36130 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36135 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36136 .cindex "mailing lists"
36137 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36138 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36139 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36141 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36142 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36143 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36144 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36148 domains = lists.example
36149 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36152 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36155 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36156 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36157 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36158 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36160 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36161 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36164 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36165 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36166 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36167 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36168 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36170 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36171 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36172 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36173 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36174 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36175 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36176 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36177 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36178 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36182 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36183 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36184 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36185 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36186 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36187 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36188 addresses are not rigorously checked.
36190 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36191 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36192 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36193 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36194 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36198 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36199 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36200 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36201 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36202 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36203 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36204 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36205 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36206 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36207 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36209 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36210 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36211 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36212 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36213 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36214 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36215 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36216 pre-existing messages.
36218 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36219 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36220 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36221 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36222 one level of expansion anyway.
36226 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36227 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36228 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36229 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36230 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36231 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36233 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36234 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36238 domains = lists.example
36239 local_part_suffix = -request
36240 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
36245 domains = lists.example
36246 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36247 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36248 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36251 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36256 domains = lists.example
36258 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36260 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36261 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36262 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36265 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36266 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36267 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36268 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36269 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36270 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36271 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36272 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36273 &"unrouteable address"& error.
36275 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36276 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36277 the address, giving a suitable error message.
36282 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36284 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36285 .cindex "envelope from"
36286 .cindex "envelope sender"
36287 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36288 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36289 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36290 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36291 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36292 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36294 .oindex &%errors_to%&
36295 .oindex &%return_path%&
36296 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36297 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36298 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36299 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36300 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36301 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36302 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36308 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36309 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36311 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36312 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36313 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36314 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36315 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36316 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36317 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36320 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36322 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36323 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36324 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36325 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36326 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36327 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36329 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36330 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36331 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36332 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36336 domains = ! +local_domains
36338 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36339 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36342 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36343 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36344 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36345 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36348 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36349 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36350 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36351 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36352 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36356 domains = ! +local_domains
36357 transport = remote_smtp
36359 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36360 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36363 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36364 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36365 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36366 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36369 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36370 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36371 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36372 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36373 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36374 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36382 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36383 .cindex "virtual domains"
36384 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
36385 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36389 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36390 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36391 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36393 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36394 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36395 have login accounts on that host.
36398 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36399 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36400 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36401 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36402 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36403 to a router of this form:
36407 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36408 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
36411 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36412 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36413 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
36414 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36415 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36416 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36418 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36419 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36420 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36421 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36423 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36424 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36425 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36429 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36430 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36431 transport = my_mailboxes
36433 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36434 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36435 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36436 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36437 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36441 driver = appendfile
36442 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36445 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36446 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36448 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36449 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36450 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36451 information about the domains.
36455 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36456 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36457 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36458 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
36459 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
36460 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36461 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36462 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36463 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36464 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36465 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36466 example, consider this router:
36471 file = $home/.forward
36472 local_part_suffix = -*
36473 local_part_suffix_optional
36476 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36477 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36478 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36479 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36481 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36482 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36485 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36486 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36487 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36488 control over which suffixes are valid.
36490 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36491 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36497 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36498 local_part_suffix = -*
36499 local_part_suffix_optional
36502 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36503 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36504 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36505 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36506 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36510 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36511 .cindex "vacation processing"
36512 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36513 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36514 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36515 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36516 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36519 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36520 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36521 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36522 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36524 spqr, vacation-spqr
36527 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36528 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36529 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36530 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36531 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36535 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36536 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36540 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36541 .cindex "message" "copying every"
36542 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36543 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36544 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36545 each day's messages.
36547 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36548 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36549 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36550 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36554 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36555 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36556 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36557 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36558 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36559 permanently connected.
36561 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36562 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36563 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36566 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36567 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36568 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36569 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36570 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36571 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36572 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36573 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36575 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36576 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36577 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36578 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36579 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36580 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36583 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36584 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36585 intermittent host. For example:
36587 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36589 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36590 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36591 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36592 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36593 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36594 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36597 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36598 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36599 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36600 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36601 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36602 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36603 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36607 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36608 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36609 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36610 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36611 delivered immediately.
36613 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36614 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36615 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36616 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36617 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36618 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36619 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36620 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36621 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36622 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36623 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36624 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36625 single SMTP connection.
36629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36632 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36633 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36634 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
36635 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36636 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36637 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36638 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36639 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36640 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36641 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36644 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36645 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36646 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36647 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36648 email is not desirable.
36650 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36651 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36652 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36653 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36654 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36655 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36656 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36658 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36659 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36660 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36661 before sending a message to the smart host.
36663 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36664 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36665 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36667 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36668 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36669 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36670 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36671 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36672 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36673 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36675 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36679 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36680 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36682 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36683 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36684 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36685 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36686 successful, a zero return code is given.
36688 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36689 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36690 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36691 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36692 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36695 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36696 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36697 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36699 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36700 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36701 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36702 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36703 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36705 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36706 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36707 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36709 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36710 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36711 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36712 are ever generated.
36714 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36716 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36717 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36718 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36721 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36722 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36723 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36724 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36725 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36726 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36731 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36732 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36734 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36735 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36736 .cindex "log" "types of"
36737 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36742 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36743 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36744 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36745 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36746 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36747 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36748 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36749 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36751 .cindex "reject log"
36752 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36753 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36754 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36755 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36756 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36757 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36758 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36759 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36760 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36763 .cindex "panic log"
36764 .cindex "system log"
36765 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36766 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36767 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36768 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36769 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36770 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36771 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36772 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36773 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36776 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36777 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36778 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36780 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36783 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36784 ways of changing this:
36787 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36792 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36794 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36797 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36801 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36802 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36803 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36804 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36805 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36806 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36811 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36812 .cindex "log" "destination"
36813 .cindex "log" "to file"
36814 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
36816 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36817 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36818 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36819 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36820 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36821 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36822 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36824 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36825 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
36826 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36827 references to the host name:
36829 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36831 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36832 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
36833 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36834 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36835 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36838 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36839 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36840 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36841 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36842 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36843 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36844 implying the use of a default path.
36846 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36847 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36848 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36849 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36850 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36851 equivalent to the setting:
36853 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36855 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
36856 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36857 that is where the logs are written.
36859 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
36860 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36862 Here are some examples of possible settings:
36864 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36865 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36866 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36867 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36869 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36874 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36875 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36876 .cindex "cycling logs"
36877 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36878 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36879 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36880 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36881 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36882 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36883 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36885 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36886 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36887 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36888 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36889 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36890 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36891 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36892 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36893 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36894 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36895 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36900 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36901 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36902 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36903 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36904 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36905 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36906 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36907 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36909 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36910 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36911 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36912 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36914 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36915 examples of names generated by the above examples:
36917 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36918 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36919 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36920 /var/log/exim/main.200212
36922 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36923 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36924 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36925 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36927 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36928 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36929 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36930 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36931 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36932 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36935 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36936 /var/log/exim-panic.log
36937 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36938 /var/log/exim/panic
36942 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36943 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36944 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36945 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36946 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36947 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36948 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36949 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36950 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36951 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36952 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36953 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36954 the time and host name to each line.
36955 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36958 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36960 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36962 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36965 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36966 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36967 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36968 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36970 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36971 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36972 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36973 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36974 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36975 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36976 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36977 RFC 3164, you should set
36979 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36981 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36982 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36984 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36985 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36986 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36987 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36988 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36989 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36990 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36991 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36992 name, and pid as added by syslog:
36994 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36995 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36996 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36997 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
37000 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
37003 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
37004 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
37005 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
37006 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
37008 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
37009 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
37010 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
37011 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
37012 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
37013 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
37015 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
37016 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
37017 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
37020 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
37022 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
37023 without modification.
37025 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
37026 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
37027 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
37032 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
37033 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
37034 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
37035 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
37036 timestamp. The flags are:
37038 &`<=`& message arrival
37039 &`(=`& message fakereject
37040 &`=>`& normal message delivery
37041 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
37042 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
37043 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
37044 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
37045 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
37049 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
37050 .cindex "log" "reception line"
37051 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37052 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
37053 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
37055 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
37056 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
37057 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
37059 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
37060 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
37061 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
37065 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
37069 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
37070 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
37071 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
37072 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
37073 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
37074 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
37075 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
37076 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
37077 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
37078 name in parentheses.
37080 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
37081 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
37082 the log containing text like these examples:
37084 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
37085 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
37087 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
37090 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
37091 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
37094 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
37095 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
37096 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
37097 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
37098 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
37099 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
37100 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
37101 suite that was used.
37103 .cindex log protocol
37104 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
37105 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
37106 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
37107 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
37108 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
37109 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
37110 authenticator name.
37112 .cindex "size" "of message"
37113 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
37114 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
37115 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
37116 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
37119 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37120 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37124 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
37125 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
37126 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37127 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37128 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37129 to fit it on the page:
37131 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37132 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
37133 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37134 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37135 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37137 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37138 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37139 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37140 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37141 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37143 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37144 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37145 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37146 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37148 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37149 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37151 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37153 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37154 parentheses afterwards.
37156 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37157 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37158 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37159 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37160 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37161 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37162 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37163 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37164 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37165 TLS cipher information is still available.
37167 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37168 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37169 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37170 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37171 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37173 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37174 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37176 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37177 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37180 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37181 .cindex "discarded messages"
37182 .cindex "message" "discarded"
37183 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37184 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37185 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37187 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37188 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37190 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37191 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37193 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37194 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37198 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37199 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37201 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37202 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37204 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37205 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37206 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37208 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37209 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37211 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37212 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37213 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37217 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37218 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37219 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37220 following form is logged:
37222 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37223 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37225 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37226 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37228 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37229 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37230 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
37231 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
37232 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
37234 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
37235 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
37236 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
37237 flagged with &`**`&.
37241 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
37242 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
37243 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
37244 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37245 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37249 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
37252 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37254 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37255 at the end of its processing.
37260 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37261 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37262 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37263 the following table:
37265 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37266 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37267 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37268 &`CV `& certificate verification status
37269 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37270 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37271 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37272 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37273 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
37274 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37275 &`H `& host name and IP address
37276 &`I `& local interface used
37277 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37278 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37279 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37280 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37281 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37282 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37283 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37284 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37285 &`Q `& alternate queue name
37286 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37287 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37288 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37289 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37290 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37291 &`S `& size of message in bytes
37292 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37293 &`ST `& shadow transport name
37294 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37295 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37296 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37297 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37298 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
37302 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37303 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37304 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37307 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37308 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37309 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37310 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37311 during the first delivery attempt.
37313 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37314 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37315 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37317 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37318 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37319 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37320 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37321 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37324 .cindex "error" "ignored"
37325 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37328 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37329 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37331 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37332 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37334 A delivery set up by a router configured with
37335 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37336 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37340 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37343 .cindex DKIM "log line"
37344 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37345 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37352 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37353 .cindex "log" "selectors"
37354 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37355 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37356 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37359 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37361 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37362 selection marked by asterisks:
37364 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37365 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37366 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37367 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37368 &` arguments `& command line arguments
37369 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37370 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37371 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
37372 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37373 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37374 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37375 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37376 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37377 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37378 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37379 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37380 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37381 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37382 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37383 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37384 &`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37385 &` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37386 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37387 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37388 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37389 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37390 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37391 &` pid `& Exim process id
37392 &` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37393 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37394 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37395 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37396 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37397 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37398 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37399 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37400 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37401 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37402 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37403 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37404 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37405 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37406 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37407 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37408 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37409 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37410 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37411 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37412 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37413 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37414 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37415 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37416 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37418 &` all `& all of the above
37420 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37421 section &<<SECID99>>&
37423 More details on each of these items follows:
37427 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37428 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37429 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37430 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37431 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37432 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37434 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37435 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37436 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37437 this log selector is set.
37439 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
37440 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37441 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37442 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37443 such users cannot access the log).
37445 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
37446 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37447 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37448 parentheses between them.
37450 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37451 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37452 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37453 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37454 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37455 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37456 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37457 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37458 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37459 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37460 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37461 between the caller and Exim.
37463 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37464 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37465 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37467 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37468 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37469 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37470 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37471 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37472 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37474 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37475 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37476 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37477 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37478 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37480 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37481 .cindex "size" "of message"
37482 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37483 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37485 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37486 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37487 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37488 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37490 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37491 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37492 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37494 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37495 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37496 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
37497 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37498 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37501 .cindex dnssec logging
37502 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37503 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37504 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37505 It does not cover helo-name verification.
37506 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37508 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37509 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37510 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37511 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37512 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37513 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37515 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37516 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37517 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37518 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37519 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37521 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37522 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37523 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37524 client's ident port times out.
37526 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37527 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37528 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37529 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37530 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37531 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37532 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37533 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37534 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37535 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37536 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37538 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37539 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37540 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37541 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37542 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37543 on a proxied connection
37544 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37545 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37547 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37548 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
37549 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37550 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37551 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37552 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37553 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37554 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37555 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37556 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37557 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37559 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37560 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37561 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37563 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37564 .cindex millisecond logging
37565 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37566 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37567 appended to the seconds value.
37570 .cindex "log" "message id"
37571 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37573 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37574 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37575 (submission mode) without one.
37576 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37579 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37580 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37581 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37582 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37583 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37584 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37585 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37586 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37587 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37589 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37590 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37591 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37592 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37593 containing => tags) following the IP address.
37594 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37595 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37596 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37597 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37598 local port is a random ephemeral port.
37600 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
37601 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37602 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37603 immediately after the time and date.
37605 .cindex log pipelining
37606 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37607 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37608 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37609 The field is a single "L".
37611 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37612 the field has a minus appended.
37615 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
37616 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
37617 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
37618 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
37619 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
37623 .cindex "log" "queue run"
37624 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37625 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37627 .cindex "log" "queue time"
37628 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37629 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37630 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37631 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37632 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37633 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37634 message has been successfully received.
37635 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37636 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37638 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37639 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37640 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37641 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37643 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
37644 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37645 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37646 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37647 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37649 .cindex "log" "recipients"
37650 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37651 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37652 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37653 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37655 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37658 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
37659 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37660 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37661 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37663 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37664 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37665 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37666 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37667 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37669 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
37670 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37671 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37672 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37675 .cindex "log" "return path"
37676 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37677 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37678 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37679 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37681 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37682 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37683 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37684 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37685 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37687 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37688 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37689 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37690 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37693 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
37694 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37697 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37698 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37699 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37700 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37702 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37703 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37705 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37706 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37707 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37708 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37709 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37710 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37713 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37714 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37715 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37716 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37717 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37718 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37719 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37720 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37721 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37722 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37724 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37725 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37726 reset if the daemon is restarted.
37727 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37728 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37729 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37730 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37731 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37733 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37734 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37735 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37736 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37737 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37738 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37740 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37741 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37742 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37743 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37744 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37745 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37746 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37747 already have their own log lines.
37749 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37750 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37751 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37752 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37753 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37754 the same logging options.
37756 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37757 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37761 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37762 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37763 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37764 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37765 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37767 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37768 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37769 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37770 was accepted or used.
37772 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37773 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37774 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37775 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37776 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37777 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37778 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37779 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37781 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37782 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37783 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37784 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37785 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37786 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37787 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37788 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37789 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37791 .cindex "log" "subject"
37792 .cindex "subject, logging"
37793 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37794 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37795 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37796 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37797 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37799 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37801 .cindex DANE logging
37802 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37803 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37805 using a CA trust anchor,
37806 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37807 and &`CV=no`& if not.
37809 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37810 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37811 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37812 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37814 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37815 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37816 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37817 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37818 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37820 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37821 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37822 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37823 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37824 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37826 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37827 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37828 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37832 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
37833 .cindex "message" "log file for"
37834 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37835 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37836 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37837 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37838 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37839 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37840 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37841 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37842 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37843 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37844 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37846 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37847 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37848 &%message_logs%& option false.
37854 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37855 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37857 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37858 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37859 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37860 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
37861 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
37863 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
37864 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
37865 "list what Exim processes are doing"
37866 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
37867 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
37868 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
37869 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
37871 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
37872 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
37873 "extract statistics from the log"
37874 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
37875 "check address acceptance from given IP"
37876 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
37877 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
37878 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
37879 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
37880 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
37881 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
37884 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
37885 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
37886 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
37891 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
37892 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
37893 .cindex "process, querying"
37895 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
37896 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
37897 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
37898 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
37899 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
37900 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37901 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37902 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37904 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37905 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37906 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37909 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37910 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37911 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37912 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37913 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37916 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37917 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37918 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37919 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37921 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37923 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
37924 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
37925 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37926 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
37927 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
37928 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37930 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37931 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37935 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37936 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37937 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
37938 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37942 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37946 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37947 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37949 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37950 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37953 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37954 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37955 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37959 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37960 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37961 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37963 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37964 Match against the size field.
37966 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37967 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37969 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37970 Match messages that are older than the given time.
37973 Match only frozen messages.
37976 Match only non-frozen messages.
37979 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
37980 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
37984 The following options control the format of the output:
37988 Display only the count of matching messages.
37991 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37995 Display message ids only.
37998 Brief format &-- one line per message.
38001 Display messages in reverse order.
38004 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
38007 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
38011 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
38012 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
38013 .cindex "queue" "summary"
38014 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
38015 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
38016 running a command such as
38018 exim -bp | exiqsumm
38020 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
38021 it, as in the following example:
38023 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
38025 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
38026 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
38027 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
38028 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
38030 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
38031 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
38032 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
38033 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
38034 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
38035 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
38038 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
38039 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
38040 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
38041 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
38042 level"& addresses).
38047 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
38049 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
38050 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
38051 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
38052 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
38053 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
38054 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
38055 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
38056 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
38057 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
38058 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
38060 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
38062 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
38064 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
38065 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
38066 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
38068 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
38069 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
38070 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
38071 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
38072 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
38074 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
38075 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
38076 regular expression.
38078 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
38079 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
38081 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
38082 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
38086 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
38087 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
38088 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
38089 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
38090 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
38091 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
38094 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
38095 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
38096 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
38097 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
38098 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
38101 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
38102 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
38103 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
38104 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
38105 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
38106 the &%--help%& option.
38109 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
38110 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38111 .cindex "cycling logs"
38112 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38113 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
38114 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
38115 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
38116 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
38117 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
38118 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
38120 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
38121 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
38123 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
38124 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
38125 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38129 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38130 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38131 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38132 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38133 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38134 logs are handled similarly.
38136 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38137 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38138 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38139 any existing log files.
38141 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38142 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38143 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38144 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38145 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38147 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38149 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38150 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38154 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38155 .cindex "statistics"
38156 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38157 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38158 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38159 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38160 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38162 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38163 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38164 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38165 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38166 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38168 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38170 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38171 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38172 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38173 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38174 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38175 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38176 also produced per user.
38178 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38179 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38180 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38181 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38182 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38184 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38185 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38186 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38187 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38188 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38189 an entirely separate message.
38191 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38192 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38193 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38194 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38195 least one address that failed.
38197 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38198 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38199 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38200 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38201 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38202 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38203 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38205 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38206 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38207 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38209 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38210 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38211 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38213 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38216 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38217 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38218 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38219 .cindex "checking access"
38220 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38221 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38222 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38223 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38224 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38225 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38227 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38228 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38230 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38232 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38233 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38234 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38235 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
38238 550 Relay not permitted
38240 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
38241 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
38242 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
38243 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
38246 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
38247 -f himself@there.example
38249 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
38250 mandatory arguments.
38252 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
38253 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
38254 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
38258 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38259 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38260 .cindex "building DBM files"
38261 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38262 .cindex "lower casing"
38263 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38264 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38265 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38266 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38267 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38268 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38270 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38271 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38272 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38273 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38276 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38277 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38278 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38282 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38283 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38284 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38285 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38287 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38289 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38290 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38292 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38293 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38294 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38295 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38296 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38297 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38299 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38300 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38301 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38302 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38303 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38304 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38305 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38311 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38312 .cindex "retry" "times"
38313 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
38314 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38315 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38316 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38317 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38318 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38319 output. For example:
38321 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38322 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38323 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38324 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38325 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38326 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38327 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38328 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38329 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38330 past final cutoff time
38332 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38333 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38334 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38335 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38336 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38337 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38340 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38341 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38342 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38343 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38344 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38345 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38349 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38350 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38351 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38352 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38353 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38354 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38355 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38358 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
38360 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38363 &'callout'&: the callout cache
38365 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38367 &'misc'&: other hints data
38370 The &'misc'& database is used for
38373 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38375 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38376 &(smtp)& transport)
38378 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38384 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38385 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38386 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38387 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38388 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38390 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38392 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38394 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
38395 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38397 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38398 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38399 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38400 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38401 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38402 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38403 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38404 and a textual description of the error.
38406 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38407 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38408 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38411 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38412 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38413 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38414 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38415 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38416 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38421 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38422 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38423 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38424 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38425 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38426 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38427 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38428 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38429 updated sufficiently often.
38431 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38432 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38433 the retry database:
38435 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38437 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38438 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38439 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38440 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38441 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38442 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38443 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38444 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38445 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38446 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38447 whenever it removes information from the database.
38449 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38450 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38451 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38452 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38453 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38455 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38456 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38457 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38458 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38459 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38460 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38461 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38464 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38465 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38470 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38471 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38472 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38473 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38474 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38475 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38476 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38479 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38480 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38481 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38482 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38483 by new data, for example:
38487 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38488 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38489 used as optional separators.
38494 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38495 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38496 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38497 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
38498 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38499 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38500 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38501 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38502 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38503 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38504 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38505 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38506 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38510 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38513 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38516 .vitem &%-interval%&
38517 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38518 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38520 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
38521 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38524 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38527 Suppress verification output.
38529 .vitem &%-retries%&
38530 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38531 the lock (default 10).
38533 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
38534 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38535 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38536 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38539 .vitem &%-timeout%&
38540 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38541 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38542 default), a non-blocking call is used.
38545 Generate verbose output.
38548 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38549 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38550 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38551 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38552 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38553 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38554 more than 30 minutes old.
38556 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38557 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38558 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38559 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38560 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38561 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38563 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38564 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38565 suppresses all output except error messages.
38569 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38571 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38573 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38574 <&'some commands'&>
38577 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38578 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38581 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38582 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38584 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38585 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38589 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38590 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38592 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38593 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38594 .cindex "X-windows"
38595 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
38596 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38597 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38598 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38599 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38600 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38601 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38602 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38606 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38607 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38608 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38609 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38610 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38611 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38612 parameters are for.
38614 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38615 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38616 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38618 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38620 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38621 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38622 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38623 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38624 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38626 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38627 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38629 Eximon*background: gray94
38631 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38632 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38633 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38634 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38635 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38636 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38637 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38640 Eximon*highlight: gray
38643 .cindex "admin user"
38644 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
38645 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38647 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38648 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38649 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38650 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38651 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38653 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38654 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38655 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38656 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38657 different parts of the display.
38662 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38663 .cindex "stripchart"
38664 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
38665 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38666 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38667 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38668 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38669 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38670 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38671 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38672 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38674 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38675 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38676 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38677 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38679 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38680 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38681 to a single partition.
38683 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38684 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38685 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38686 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38687 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38688 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38689 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38694 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38695 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38696 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38697 .cindex "window size"
38698 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38699 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38700 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38701 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38702 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38703 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38705 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38706 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38707 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38708 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38710 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38711 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38712 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38713 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38714 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38715 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38717 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38718 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38719 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38723 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
38724 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38725 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38726 the main log is maintained.
38727 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38728 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38729 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38730 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38731 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38733 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38734 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38735 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38736 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38737 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38738 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38739 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38740 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38741 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38742 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38743 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38745 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38746 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38747 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38748 It cannot go further back up the log.
38750 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38751 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38752 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38753 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38754 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38755 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38757 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38758 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38759 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38760 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38761 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38762 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38764 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38765 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38766 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38767 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38768 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38769 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38770 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38771 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38772 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38777 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38778 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38779 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38780 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38781 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38782 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38783 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38784 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38785 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38786 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38788 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38789 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
38790 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38791 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38792 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38793 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38794 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38796 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38797 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38798 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38799 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38800 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38801 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38802 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38804 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38805 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38806 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38807 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38809 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38810 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38811 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38812 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38813 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38814 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38815 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38818 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38819 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38821 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38822 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38823 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38824 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38825 display is updated.
38829 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38830 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38831 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38832 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38833 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38836 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38837 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38838 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38839 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38840 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38842 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38844 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38848 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38849 in a new text window.
38851 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38852 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38853 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38855 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38856 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38857 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38858 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
38860 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38861 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38862 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
38863 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
38864 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
38866 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
38867 that the message be frozen.
38869 .cindex "thawing messages"
38870 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
38871 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
38872 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
38873 that the message be thawed.
38875 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
38876 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
38877 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
38878 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
38880 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
38881 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
38884 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
38885 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38886 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38887 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38888 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
38889 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
38890 which case no action is taken.
38892 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
38893 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38894 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38895 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38896 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
38897 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
38898 case no action is taken.
38900 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
38901 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
38903 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
38904 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
38905 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38906 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38907 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38908 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38909 the address is qualified with that domain.
38912 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38913 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38914 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38915 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38916 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38917 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38918 if no output is generated.
38920 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38921 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38922 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38923 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38925 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38926 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38927 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38934 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38935 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38937 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38938 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38939 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38940 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38942 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38943 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38944 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38945 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38946 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38947 its security as compared with other MTAs.
38949 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38950 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38951 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38952 as soon as possible.
38955 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38956 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
38957 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38958 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38959 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38960 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38963 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38964 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
38965 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
38966 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38967 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38968 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38970 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38971 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38972 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38973 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38976 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38977 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38978 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38979 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38980 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38981 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38982 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38983 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38984 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38988 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38989 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38990 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38991 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38992 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38993 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38994 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38996 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38999 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
39000 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
39001 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
39002 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
39003 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
39008 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
39010 .cindex "root privilege"
39011 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
39012 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
39013 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
39014 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
39015 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
39016 is required for two things:
39019 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
39020 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
39023 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
39024 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
39028 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
39029 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
39030 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
39031 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
39032 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
39033 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
39034 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
39035 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
39037 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
39038 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
39039 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
39041 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
39042 uid and gid in the following cases:
39047 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
39048 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
39049 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
39050 the calling process.
39051 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
39052 option may not be used at all.
39053 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
39054 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
39055 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
39060 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
39061 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
39064 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
39065 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
39066 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
39067 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
39068 testing address verification
39071 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
39074 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
39075 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
39078 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
39081 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
39082 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
39083 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
39084 will be used during message reception.
39086 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
39087 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
39089 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
39090 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
39091 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
39092 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
39093 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
39094 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
39095 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
39096 generating bounce and warning messages.
39098 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
39099 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
39100 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
39101 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
39103 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
39104 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
39110 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
39111 .cindex "privilege, running without"
39112 .cindex "unprivileged running"
39113 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
39114 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
39115 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
39116 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
39117 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
39118 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
39119 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
39123 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
39124 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
39125 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
39126 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39128 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39129 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39130 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39131 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39132 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39134 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39135 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39136 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39139 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39140 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39141 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39143 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39144 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39145 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39146 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39147 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39148 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39149 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39150 address this problem at this time.
39152 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39153 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39154 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39155 be used in the most straightforward way.
39157 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39158 number of restrictions on what you can do:
39161 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39162 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39163 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39164 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39165 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39167 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39168 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39170 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39171 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39172 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39173 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39175 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39176 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39179 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39180 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39181 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39183 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39184 owned by the Exim user.
39186 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39187 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39188 mailboxes need to be created manually.
39193 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39194 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39195 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39196 gives more security at essentially no cost.
39198 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39199 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39204 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39205 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39206 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39210 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39211 .cindex "security" "local commands"
39212 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39213 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39214 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39215 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39216 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39219 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39220 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39221 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39222 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39223 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39225 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39226 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39227 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39228 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39229 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39230 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39231 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39233 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39234 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39235 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
39237 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
39238 taint checking might apply to their usage.
39240 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
39241 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
39242 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
39244 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
39245 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
39246 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
39248 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
39249 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
39250 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
39251 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
39257 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
39258 .cindex "security" "data sources"
39259 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39260 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39261 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
39262 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39263 are some issues to be aware of:
39266 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39268 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39270 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39271 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39272 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39273 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39274 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39275 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39278 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39279 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39280 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39282 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39283 expected to yield one result.
39289 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39290 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39291 .cindex "IP source routing"
39292 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39293 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39294 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39295 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39299 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39300 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39301 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39306 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39307 .cindex "trusted users"
39308 .cindex "admin user"
39309 .cindex "privileged user"
39310 .cindex "user" "trusted"
39311 .cindex "user" "admin"
39312 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39313 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39314 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39315 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39316 permit a remote host to be specified.
39319 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39320 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39321 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39322 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39323 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39324 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39326 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39327 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39328 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39329 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39330 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39332 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39333 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39334 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39335 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39336 includes the contents of files on the spool.
39340 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39341 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39342 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39343 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39344 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39345 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39347 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39348 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39349 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39350 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39351 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39352 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39355 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39356 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39357 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39358 This affects most of the checking options,
39359 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39362 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39363 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
39364 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39365 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39366 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39367 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39371 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39372 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39373 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39374 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39375 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39380 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39381 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39382 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39383 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39388 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39389 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39390 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39391 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39392 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39396 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39397 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39398 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39402 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39403 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39404 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39405 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39406 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39407 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39408 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39410 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39411 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39416 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39417 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39418 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39419 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39423 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39424 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39425 enough to hold the result.
39426 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
39431 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39432 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39434 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39435 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39436 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39437 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39438 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
39439 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39440 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39441 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39442 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39443 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39444 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39445 themselves are recoverable.
39447 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39448 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39449 and should not be used as such.
39451 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39452 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39453 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39456 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39457 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39458 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39459 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39460 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39462 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39463 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39464 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39465 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39467 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39469 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39472 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39474 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39475 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39476 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39477 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39478 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39479 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39480 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39481 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39484 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39485 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39486 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39487 relics of crashes and can be removed.
39489 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39490 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39491 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39492 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39493 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39494 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39495 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39496 normally the Exim user.
39498 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39499 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39500 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39501 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39502 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39503 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39504 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39505 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39507 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39508 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39509 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39510 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39512 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39513 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39516 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39517 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39518 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39519 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39520 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39521 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39522 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39523 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39524 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39527 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39528 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39529 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39530 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39531 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39532 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39534 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39535 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39536 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39537 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39538 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39539 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39541 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39542 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39543 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39545 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39546 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39547 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39548 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39549 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39551 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39552 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39553 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39554 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39555 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39557 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39558 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39559 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39561 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39562 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39563 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39565 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39566 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39567 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39569 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39570 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39571 present if the number is greater than zero.
39573 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39574 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39575 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39577 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39578 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39579 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39581 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39582 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39585 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39586 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39587 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39590 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39591 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39592 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39593 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39595 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39596 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39597 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39599 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39600 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39601 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39602 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39603 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39604 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39606 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39607 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39608 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39609 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39610 supplied by the remote host, if any.
39612 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39613 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39614 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39615 generated messages.
39618 The message is from a local sender.
39620 .vitem &%-localerror%&
39621 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39623 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39624 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39625 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39626 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39628 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39629 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39630 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39633 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39634 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39637 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39638 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39639 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39641 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39642 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39643 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39645 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39646 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39647 of &$spam_score_int$&.
39649 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39650 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39651 rather than Unix-format.
39652 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39653 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39655 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39656 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39657 certificate was verified by the server.
39659 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39660 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39661 name of the cipher suite that was used.
39663 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39664 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39665 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39670 Any of the above may have an extra hyphen prepended, to indicate the the
39671 corresponding data is untrusted.
39674 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39675 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39676 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39677 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39678 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39679 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39680 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39681 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39682 addresses are complete.
39684 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39685 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39686 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39687 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39688 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39689 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39691 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39692 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39693 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39695 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39696 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39697 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39698 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39702 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39703 darcy@austen.fict.example
39705 alice@wonderland.fict.example
39707 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39708 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39709 line is of the following form:
39711 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39712 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39714 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39715 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39716 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39717 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39718 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39719 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39720 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39721 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39724 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39725 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39726 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39727 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39728 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39732 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39733 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39734 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39735 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39736 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39737 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39738 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39739 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39740 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39741 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39744 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39745 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39746 typical set of headers:
39748 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39749 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39750 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39751 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39752 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39753 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39754 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39755 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39756 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39757 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39758 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39760 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39761 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39762 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39763 .ecindex IIDforspo1
39764 .ecindex IIDforspo2
39765 .ecindex IIDforspo3
39767 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39768 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39769 an ASCII newline character.
39770 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39771 can have an alternate format.
39772 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39773 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39774 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39775 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39776 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39777 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39779 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39780 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39782 .chapter "DKIM, SPF and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39783 "DKIM, SPF and DMARC Support"
39785 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39788 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39789 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39790 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39791 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39793 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39794 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39795 any original DKIM signature.
39797 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39798 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39800 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39802 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39803 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39804 (including transport filters)
39805 except cutthrough delivery.
39807 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39808 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39809 different signature contexts.
39812 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39813 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39814 Exim's standard controls.
39816 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39817 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39819 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39820 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39821 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39822 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39824 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39825 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39826 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39827 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39830 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39831 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39832 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39833 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39837 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39838 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39840 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39841 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
39843 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39845 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39846 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39849 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39850 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39851 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39852 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39853 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39855 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39856 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39858 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39859 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39860 After expansion, this can be a list.
39861 Each element in turn,
39865 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39866 while expanding the remaining signing options.
39867 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
39868 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39870 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
39871 This sets the key selector string.
39872 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
39873 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
39874 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
39875 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
39876 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
39877 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39879 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
39880 This sets the private key to use.
39881 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
39882 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
39883 The result can either
39885 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
39887 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39888 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
39890 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
39893 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
39894 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
39898 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
39900 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
39901 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
39903 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
39904 for the DNS TXT record.
39905 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
39909 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
39910 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
39913 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39915 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39916 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39920 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
39922 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39923 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39924 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39925 for some transition period.
39926 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39929 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39931 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39932 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39935 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39937 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39938 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39942 Exim also supports an alternate format
39943 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
39944 of the standard, but not adopted.
39945 A future release will probably drop that support.
39948 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39949 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
39951 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
39953 &`sha256`& &-- the default
39955 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
39958 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39960 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39963 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
39964 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
39965 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
39966 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
39967 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
39968 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39970 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39971 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39972 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39973 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39974 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39976 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39977 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39978 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39979 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39980 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39983 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39984 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39985 list of header names.
39986 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39987 in the message signature.
39988 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39989 whether or not each header is present in the message.
39990 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39991 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39993 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39994 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39995 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39997 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39998 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
40000 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
40001 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
40002 name will be appended.
40004 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
40005 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
40006 If not set, no such information will be included.
40007 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
40009 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
40010 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
40012 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
40015 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
40016 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
40018 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
40019 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
40021 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
40022 Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
40023 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
40024 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
40025 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
40028 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40029 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40030 &%authresults%& expansion item.
40033 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
40034 of this section can be ignored.
40037 The results of verification are made available to the
40038 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
40039 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
40040 By default, the ACL is called once for each
40041 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
40042 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
40043 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
40044 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
40046 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
40047 a large number of expansion variables
40048 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
40049 runtime of the ACL.
40051 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
40052 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
40053 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
40054 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
40056 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
40057 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
40058 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
40059 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
40060 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
40061 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
40064 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
40066 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
40067 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
40068 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
40070 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
40072 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
40073 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
40074 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
40076 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
40079 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
40080 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
40083 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
40084 (such as the From: header)
40085 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
40086 and for the domain part if identities.
40087 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
40090 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
40091 for each matching signature.
40094 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
40095 available (from most to least important):
40099 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
40100 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
40101 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
40102 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
40104 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
40105 Within the DKIM ACL,
40106 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
40108 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
40109 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40111 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
40112 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40114 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
40115 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40117 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
40120 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40121 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
40122 hash-method or key-size:
40124 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
40125 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
40126 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
40127 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
40128 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
40129 set dkim_verify_status = fail
40130 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
40133 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
40134 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
40135 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
40136 This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
40138 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
40139 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
40140 "fail" or "invalid". One of
40142 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
40143 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40145 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40146 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40148 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40149 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40150 means that the message body was modified in transit.
40152 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40153 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40154 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40155 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40158 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40160 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40161 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40162 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40163 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40165 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40166 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40167 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40168 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40170 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40171 The key record selector string.
40173 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40174 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40175 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40176 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40177 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40180 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40182 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40184 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40185 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40188 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40189 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
40191 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
40192 processing of such signatures.
40195 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40196 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40198 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40199 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40201 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40202 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40203 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40204 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40205 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40206 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40208 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40209 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40210 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40211 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40212 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40213 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40214 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40215 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40217 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40218 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40219 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40221 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40222 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40223 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40224 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40225 integer size comparisons against this value.
40226 Note that Exim does not check this value.
40228 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40229 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40231 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40232 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40234 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40235 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40237 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40238 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40241 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40242 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40245 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40246 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
40248 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
40249 Number of bits in the key.
40251 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40253 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
40254 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
40257 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40258 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
40259 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
40263 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
40266 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
40267 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
40268 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
40269 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
40270 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
40273 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
40274 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
40275 sender_domains = gmail.com
40276 dkim_signers = gmail.com
40280 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40281 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40283 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
40284 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40285 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40286 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40289 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40290 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40291 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40292 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40295 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40296 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40297 for more information of what they mean.
40303 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40304 .cindex SPF verification
40306 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40307 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40308 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
40309 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https
40311 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40312 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40314 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40315 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40316 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40317 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40318 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40320 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40321 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40322 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40323 &%authresults%& expansion item.
40326 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40327 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
40328 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40329 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40330 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40334 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40337 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40338 domain in the envelope-from address.
40340 .vitem &%softfail%&
40341 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40345 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40348 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40349 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40350 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40352 .vitem &%permerror%&
40353 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40354 You may deny messages when this occurs.
40356 .vitem &%temperror%&
40357 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40358 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40361 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40362 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40363 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40364 short-circuit fashion.
40369 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40370 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40371 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40372 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
40373 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40374 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40375 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40376 ip=$sender_host_address
40379 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40382 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
40384 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40385 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40386 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40387 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40388 it for logging purposes.
40390 .vitem &$spf_received$&
40391 .vindex &$spf_received$&
40392 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40393 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40394 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40395 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40397 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40398 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40400 .vitem &$spf_result$&
40401 .vindex &$spf_result$&
40402 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40403 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40406 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40407 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40408 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40409 and required in order to obtain a result.
40411 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40412 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40413 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40414 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40418 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40419 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40420 .cindex SPF "best guess"
40421 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40422 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40423 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40425 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40426 for a description of what it means.
40427 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https:
40429 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40430 of the spf one. For example:
40433 deny spf_guess = fail
40434 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40437 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40438 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40439 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40442 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40443 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40445 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40446 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40447 &%spf_guess%& option.
40448 For example, the following:
40451 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40454 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40457 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40459 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40460 address as the key and an IP address
40467 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40470 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40471 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40478 .section DMARC SECDMARC
40479 .cindex DMARC verification
40481 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
40482 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
40483 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
40484 should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
40485 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
40487 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
40488 the libopendmarc library is used.
40490 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
40491 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
40492 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite rpm package
40493 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
40494 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
40495 This description assumes
40496 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
40497 are in /usr/local/lib.
40501 There are three main-configuration options:
40502 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
40504 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
40505 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
40506 defines the location of a text file of valid
40507 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
40508 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
40509 the most current version can be downloaded
40510 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/, currently pointing
40511 at https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat)
40512 See also util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
40513 The default for the option is /etc/exim/opendmarc.tlds.
40516 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
40517 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
40518 defines the location of a file to log results
40519 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
40520 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
40521 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
40522 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
40523 directory of this file is writable by the user
40525 The default is unset.
40527 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
40528 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
40529 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
40530 forensic report detailing alignment failures
40531 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
40532 and you have configured Exim to send them.
40533 If set, this is expanded and used for the
40534 From: header line; the address is extracted
40535 from it and used for the envelope from.
40536 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
40537 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
40540 . I wish we had subsections...
40542 .cindex DMARC controls
40543 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
40544 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
40545 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
40546 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
40547 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
40548 DMARC with a control setting:
40550 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40552 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
40553 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
40554 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
40555 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
40556 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
40557 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
40558 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
40559 exim will send these forensic emails. It's also advised that you
40560 configure a dmarc_forensic_sender because the default sender address
40561 construction might be inadequate.
40563 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40565 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
40566 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
40567 your exim config. If you don't tell it to send them, it will not
40570 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
40575 DMARC checks cam be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
40576 "dmarc_status" ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
40577 call the "spf" condition first in the ACLs, then the "dmarc_status"
40578 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
40579 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
40580 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
40581 occurs until a "dmarc_status" condition is encountered in the ACLs.
40583 The dmarc_status condition takes a list of strings on its
40584 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
40585 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
40586 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
40588 &'accept '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email.
40589 &'reject '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email.
40590 &'quarantine '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection.
40591 &'none '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral.
40592 &'norecord '& No policy section in the DMARC record for this sender domain.
40593 &'nofrom '& Unable to determine the domain of the sender.
40594 &'temperror '& Library error or dns error.
40595 &'off '& The DMARC check was disabled for this email.
40597 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
40598 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
40599 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
40600 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
40601 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
40602 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
40605 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
40606 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
40607 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
40609 Performing the check sets up information used by the
40610 &%authresults%& expansion item.
40612 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
40613 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
40614 expansion variables are available:
40617 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
40618 .cindex DMARC result
40619 is a one word status indicating what the DMARC library
40620 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
40621 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
40622 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
40623 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
40625 &$dmarc_status_text$&
40626 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
40627 is a slightly longer, human readable status.
40629 &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40630 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40631 is the domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
40633 &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40634 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40635 is the policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
40636 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
40637 is any error, including no DMARC record.
40641 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
40642 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
40643 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
40644 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
40645 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
40646 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
40647 processing or failure delivery issues).
40649 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
40650 tools, you need to:
40652 Configure the global setting dmarc_history_file
40654 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
40655 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
40658 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
40660 Configure the global setting dmarc_forensic_sender
40662 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
40663 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
40671 warn domains = +local_domains
40672 hosts = +local_hosts
40673 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40675 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
40676 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40678 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
40679 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
40682 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
40684 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
40686 warn dmarc_status = !accept
40688 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
40690 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
40692 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
40693 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
40695 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
40696 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
40697 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
40699 deny dmarc_status = reject
40701 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
40703 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
40711 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40712 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40714 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
40716 .cindex "proxy support"
40717 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
40719 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
40720 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
40723 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
40724 .cindex proxy inbound
40725 .cindex proxy "server side"
40726 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
40727 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
40729 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
40730 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
40731 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
40734 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
40735 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
40737 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
40738 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
40739 to distribute load.
40740 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
40741 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
40742 There is no logging if a host passes or
40743 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
40744 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
40746 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
40747 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
40748 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
40749 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
40750 automatically determines which version is in use.
40752 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
40753 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
40754 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
40755 Exim and the proxy server.
40757 The following expansion variables are usable
40758 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
40761 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
40762 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
40763 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
40764 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
40765 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
40767 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
40768 there was a protocol error.
40769 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
40770 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
40772 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
40773 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
40774 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
40775 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
40776 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
40777 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
40778 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
40779 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
40780 A possible solution is:
40782 # Set max number of connections per host
40784 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
40785 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
40787 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
40788 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
40793 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
40794 .cindex proxy outbound
40795 .cindex proxy "client side"
40796 .cindex proxy SOCKS
40797 .cindex SOCKS proxy
40798 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
40799 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
40800 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
40803 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
40804 on an smtp transport.
40805 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
40806 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
40807 Each proxy specifier is a list
40808 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
40809 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
40811 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
40812 The list of options is in the following table:
40814 &'auth '& authentication method
40815 &'name '& authentication username
40816 &'pass '& authentication password
40818 &'tmo '& connection timeout
40820 &'weight '& selection bias
40823 More details on each of these options follows:
40826 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
40827 .cindex proxy authentication
40828 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
40829 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
40830 for access to the proxy.
40831 Default is &"none"&.
40833 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
40836 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
40839 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
40842 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
40845 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
40846 higher values being tried first.
40847 The default priority is 1.
40849 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
40850 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
40851 weighted by this value.
40852 The default value for selection bias is 1.
40855 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
40856 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
40857 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
40859 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
40860 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
40861 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
40862 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
40864 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40865 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40867 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
40868 "Internationalisation""
40869 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
40872 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
40874 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
40875 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
40876 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
40878 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
40879 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
40880 requirement, upon libidn2.
40882 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
40883 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
40884 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
40885 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
40886 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
40887 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
40889 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
40890 international handling for the message is enabled and
40891 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
40893 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
40894 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
40895 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
40896 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
40898 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
40899 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
40900 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
40901 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
40903 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
40904 components expanded to a-label form,
40905 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
40908 .cindex log protocol
40909 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
40910 .cindex i18n logging
40911 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
40912 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
40914 The following expansion operators can be used:
40916 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
40917 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
40918 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
40919 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
40922 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
40923 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
40925 may use the following modifier:
40927 control = utf8_downconvert
40928 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
40930 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
40931 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
40932 Message Submission Agent context.
40933 If a value is appended it may be:
40935 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
40936 &`0 `& no downconversion
40937 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
40940 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
40941 is initially set to -1.
40943 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
40944 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
40945 and it overrides any previously set value.
40948 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
40949 Configurations supporting these should inspect
40950 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
40952 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
40953 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
40954 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
40956 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
40957 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
40961 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
40962 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
40963 the following expansion operator can be used:
40965 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
40968 The string is converted from the charset specified by
40969 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
40970 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
40972 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
40973 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
40974 (which has to be a single character)
40975 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
40976 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
40978 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
40979 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
40981 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
40982 by many other IMAP servers.
40986 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
40987 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
40988 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
40991 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
40992 must be representable in UTF-16.
40995 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40996 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40998 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
41002 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
41003 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
41004 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
41005 processing actions.
41007 Most installations will never need to use Events.
41008 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
41009 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41011 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
41012 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
41013 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
41015 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
41016 An example might look like:
41017 .cindex logging custom
41019 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
41020 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
41021 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
41022 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
41023 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
41024 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
41025 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
41026 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
41027 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
41031 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
41032 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
41033 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
41035 The current list of events is:
41037 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
41038 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
41039 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41040 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
41041 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
41042 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
41043 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41044 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
41045 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
41046 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
41047 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
41048 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
41050 New event types may be added in future.
41052 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
41053 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
41054 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
41056 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
41057 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
41058 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
41060 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
41061 should define the event action.
41063 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
41064 with the event type:
41066 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
41067 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
41068 &`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
41069 &`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
41070 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
41071 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
41072 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
41073 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
41074 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
41077 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
41079 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
41080 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
41081 the course of its processing:
41083 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
41086 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
41087 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
41089 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
41090 a useful way of writing to the main log.
41092 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
41093 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
41094 following will be forced:
41096 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
41097 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
41098 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
41100 All other message types ignore the result string, and
41101 no other use is made of it.
41103 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
41104 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
41107 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
41108 chain element received on the connection.
41109 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
41112 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41113 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41115 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
41116 "Adding drivers or lookups"
41117 .cindex "adding drivers"
41118 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
41119 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
41120 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
41121 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
41124 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
41125 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
41127 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
41129 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
41131 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
41132 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
41133 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
41135 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
41137 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
41140 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
41141 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
41143 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
41144 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
41145 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
41146 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
41147 simple form that most lookups have.
41149 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
41150 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
41151 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
41153 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
41154 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
41156 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
41159 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
41160 as for other drivers and lookups.
41163 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
41164 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
41165 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
41166 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
41167 searched using a binary chop procedure.
41169 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
41170 the interface that is expected.
41175 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41176 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41178 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41179 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
41180 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
41181 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
41183 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41188 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
41189 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
41193 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
41194 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
41195 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
41198 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41199 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////